manual: remove the lists of config files
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * NAND Flash Commands:: NAND Flash Commands
77 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
78 * General Commands:: General Commands
79 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
80 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
81 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
82 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
83 * TFTP:: TFTP
84 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
85 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
86 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
87 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
88 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
89
90 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
91 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
92 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
93 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
94 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
95 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
96 @end menu
97
98 @node About
99 @unnumbered About
100 @cindex about
101
102 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
103 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
104 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
105 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
106 around the world.
107
108 @section What is OpenOCD?
109 @cindex TAP
110 @cindex JTAG
111
112 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
113 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
114 devices.
115
116 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
117 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
118 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
119 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
120 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
121 needed to hook up to the target.
122
123 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
124 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
125 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
126 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
127 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
128
129 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
130 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
131 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
132 let the development board connect directly to the debug
133 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
134
135 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
136 signaling, and is used to communicate
137 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
138 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
139 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
140 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
141 scan operations.
142
143 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
144 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
145 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
146 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
147
148 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
149 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
150 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
151 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
152
153
154 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
155 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
156 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
157
158 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
159 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
160 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
161 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
162
163 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
164 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
165 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
166 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
167 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
168
169 @section OpenOCD Web Site
170
171 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
172
173 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
174
175 @section Latest User's Guide:
176
177 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
178 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
179 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
180
181 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
182
183 PDF form is likewise published at:
184
185 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
186
187 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
188
189 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
190 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
191 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
192 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
193 instead of this forum.
194
195 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
196
197 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
198
199 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
200 communication between users:
201
202 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
203
204 @section OpenOCD IRC
205
206 Support can also be found on irc:
207 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
208
209 @node Developers
210 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
211 @cindex developers
212
213 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
214 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
215 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
216 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
217
218 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
219 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
220
221 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
222
223 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
224 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
225
226 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
227
228 or via http
229
230 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
231
232 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
233
234 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
235
236 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
237 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
238 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
239 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
240 needing a Git client:
241
242 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
243
244 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
245 from the repository or a snapshot.
246
247 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
248 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
249 Patches created against older versions may require additional
250 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
251
252 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
253
254 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
255 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
256 technical information about the software internals, development
257 processes, and similar documentation:
258
259 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
260
261 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
262 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
263 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
264
265 @section Gerrit Review System
266
267 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
268 Code Review System:
269
270 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
271
272 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
273 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
274 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
275 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
276 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
277
278 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
279 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
280 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
281 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
282 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
283
284 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
285
286 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
287 communication between developers:
288
289 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
290
291 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
292
293 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
294
295 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
296
297
298 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
300 @cindex dongles
301 @cindex FTDI
302 @cindex wiggler
303 @cindex zy1000
304 @cindex printer port
305 @cindex USB Adapter
306 @cindex RTCK
307
308 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
309 an adapter .... [snip]
310
311 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
312 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
313 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
314 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
315 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
316 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
317 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
318
319
320 @section Choosing a Dongle
321
322 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
323
324 @enumerate
325 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
326 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
327 other ways to communicate with target devices.
328 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
329 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
330 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
331 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
332 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
333 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
334 Ethernet port needed?
335 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
336 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
337 @end enumerate
338
339 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
340
341 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
342 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
343 running on the developer's host computer.
344 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
345 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
346 IP address assigned to the probe.
347 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
348 OpenOCD debugger.
349 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
350 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
351 the target.
352 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
353 to power cycle the target remotely.
354
355 For more information, visit:
356
357 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
358
359 @section USB FT2232 Based
360
361 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
362 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
363 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
364 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
365 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
366 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
367 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
368 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
369 clocking.)
370
371 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
372 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
373 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
374 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
375 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
376
377 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
378 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
379
380 @itemize @bullet
381 @item @b{usbjtag}
382 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
383 @item @b{jtagkey}
384 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
385 @item @b{jtagkey2}
386 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
387 @item @b{oocdlink}
388 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
389 @item @b{signalyzer}
390 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
391 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
392 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
393 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
394 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
395 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
396 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
397 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
398 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
399 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
400 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
401 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
402 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
403 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
404 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
405 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
406 @item @b{turtelizer2}
407 @* See:
408 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
409 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
410 @item @b{comstick}
411 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
412 @item @b{stm32stick}
413 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
414 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
415 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
416 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
417 @item @b{cortino}
418 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
419 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
420 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
421 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
422 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
423 @item @b{opendous}
424 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
425 (OpenHardware).
426 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
427 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
428
429 @item @b{GW16042}
430 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
431 FT2232H-based
432
433 @end itemize
434 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
435
436 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
437 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
438 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
439 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
440 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
441
442 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
443 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
444 (see the section on driver commands).
445
446 @itemize
447 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
448 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
449 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
450 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
451 @end itemize
452
453 @section USB JLINK based
454 There are several OEM versions of the Segger @b{JLINK} adapter. It is
455 an example of a micro controller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
456 AT91SAM764 internally.
457
458 @itemize @bullet
459 @item @b{ATMEL SAMICE} Only works with ATMEL chips!
460 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/dyn/products/tools_card.asp?tool_id=3892}
461 @item @b{SEGGER JLINK}
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
463 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
464 @* Link: @url{http://www.iar.com/en/products/hardware-debug-probes/iar-j-link/}
465 @end itemize
466
467 @section USB RLINK based
468 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
469 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
470 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
471
472 @itemize @bullet
473 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
477 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
478 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
479 @end itemize
480
481 @section USB ST-LINK based
482 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
483 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
484
485 @itemize @bullet
486 @item @b{ST-LINK}
487 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
488 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
489 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
490 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
491 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
492 @end itemize
493
494 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
495 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
496 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
497 @itemize @bullet
498 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
499 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
500 @end itemize
501
502 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
503 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
504 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
505 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
506
507 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
508 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
509 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
510
511 @section USB Other
512 @itemize @bullet
513 @item @b{USBprog}
514 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
515
516 @item @b{USB - Presto}
517 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
518
519 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
520 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
521
522 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
523 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
524
525 @item @b{Buspirate}
526 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
527
528 @item @b{opendous}
529 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
530
531 @item @b{estick}
532 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
533
534 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
536 @end itemize
537
538 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
539
540 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
541 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
542 these on the market.
543
544 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
545 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
546 of USB-based ones.
547
548 @itemize @bullet
549
550 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
551 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
552
553 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
554 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
555 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
556
557 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
558 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
559
560 @item @b{Wiggler2}
561 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
562
563 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
564 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
565
566 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
567 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
568
569 @item @b{arm-jtag}
570 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
571
572 @item @b{chameleon}
573 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
574
575 @item @b{Triton}
576 @* Unknown.
577
578 @item @b{Lattice}
579 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
580 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
581
582 @item @b{flashlink}
583 @* From ST Microsystems;
584 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
585
586 @end itemize
587
588 @section Other...
589 @itemize @bullet
590
591 @item @b{ep93xx}
592 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
593
594 @item @b{at91rm9200}
595 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
596
597 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
598 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
599
600 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
601 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
602 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
603
604 @end itemize
605
606 @node About Jim-Tcl
607 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
608 @cindex Jim-Tcl
609 @cindex tcl
610
611 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
612 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
613 command interpreter.
614
615 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
616 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
617 much of anything about Tcl.
618 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
619
620 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
621 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
622 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
623 OpenOCD mailing list.
624
625 @itemize @bullet
626 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
627 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
628 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
629 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
630 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
631 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
632
633 @item @b{Missing Features}
634 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
635 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
636 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
637 enabled in OpenOCD.
638
639 @item @b{Scripts}
640 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
641 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
642 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
643
644 @item @b{Commands}
645 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
646 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
647 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
648 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
649
650 @item @b{Historical Note}
651 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
652 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
653 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
654 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
655
656 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
657 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
658 @end itemize
659
660 @node Running
661 @chapter Running
662 @cindex command line options
663 @cindex logfile
664 @cindex directory search
665
666 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
667 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
668 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
669 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
670 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
671 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
672 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
673
674 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
675 tell it how each debug session should work.
676 The @option{--help} option shows:
677 @verbatim
678 bash$ openocd --help
679
680 --help | -h display this help
681 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
682 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
683 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
684 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
685 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
686 --command | -c run <command>
687 @end verbatim
688
689 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
690 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
691 To specify one or more different
692 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
693
694 @example
695 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
696 @end example
697
698 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
699 @enumerate
700 @item the current directory,
701 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
702 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
703 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
704 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
705 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
706 @end enumerate
707 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
708
709 @quotation Note
710 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
711 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
712 @end quotation
713
714 @section Simple setup, no customization
715
716 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
717 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
718 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
719 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
720 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
721
722 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
723 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
724 the server with some variation of one of the following:
725
726 @example
727 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
729 @end example
730
731 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
732 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
733 If all goes well you'll see output something like
734
735 @example
736 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
737 For bug reports, read
738 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
739 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
740 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
741 @end example
742
743 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
744 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
745 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
746
747 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
748
749 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
750 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
751 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
752 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
753 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
754 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
755 ensure that this always succeeds.
756 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
757 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
758 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
759 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
760
761 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
762 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
763 those channels.
764
765 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
766 the @option{-d} option.
767
768 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
769 @option{-c} command line switch.
770
771 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
772 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
773 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
774 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
775 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
776 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
777 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
778
779 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
780 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
781
782 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
783 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
784 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
785 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
786
787 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
788 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
789
790 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
791 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
792 and start the OpenOCD server.
793 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
794 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
795 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
796 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
797
798 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
799
800 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
801 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
802 and a USB cable on the other.
803 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
804 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
805
806 @enumerate
807 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
808 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
809 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
810 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
811 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
812 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
813 debugging host.
814
815 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
816 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
817 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
818 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
819 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
820
821 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
822 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
823 with 1.2 Volt boards.
824
825 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
826 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
827 ways to connect the cable.
828 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
829 Be sure it's firmly connected.
830
831 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
832 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
833 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
834 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
835 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
836 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
837 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
838 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
839
840 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
841 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
842 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
843 but are tedious to set up.
844 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
845 adapter signals to the right board pins.
846
847 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
848 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
849 you are using to run OpenOCD.
850 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
851
852 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
853 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
854 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
855 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
856
857 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
858 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
859 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
860
861 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
862 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
863 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
864 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
865
866 @end enumerate
867
868 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
869 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
870 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
871
872 @section Project Directory
873
874 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
875
876 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
877 single directory for your work with a given board.
878 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
879 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
880 files accessed through semihosting,
881 and for code you upload to the target board.
882 It is also the natural place to write files,
883 such as log files and data you download from the board.
884
885 @section Configuration Basics
886
887 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
888 a variety of ways you can mix them.
889 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
890
891 @itemize
892 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
893 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
894 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
895 @end itemize
896
897 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
898 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
899 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
900
901 @example
902 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
903
904 # GDB can also flash my flash!
905 gdb_memory_map enable
906 gdb_flash_program enable
907
908 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
909 @end example
910
911 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
912
913 @example
914 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
915 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
916 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
917 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
918 @end example
919
920 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
921 each supporting a different development task.
922 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
923 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
924
925 @quotation Important
926 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
927 problems with how it treats variables.
928 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
929 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
930 that can be tested in a later script.
931 @end quotation
932
933 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
934 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
935 to simplify your work.
936
937 @section User Config Files
938 @cindex config file, user
939 @cindex user config file
940 @cindex config file, overview
941
942 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
943 in one place.
944 One of the following will match your situation best:
945
946 @itemize
947 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
948 provided by someone else.
949 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
950 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
951 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
952 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
953 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
954 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
955
956 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
957 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
958
959 @enumerate
960 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
961 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
962 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
963 @end enumerate
964
965 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
966 The first is an interface config file.
967 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
968 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
969 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
970 meet your deadline:
971
972 @example
973 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
974 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
975 @end example
976
977 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
978 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
979 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
980 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
981
982 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
983 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
984 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
985 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
986 target and board
987 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
988 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
989
990 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
991 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
992 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
993 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
994
995 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
996 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
997 giving access to your particular flash chips.
998 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
999 for a new chip built around the Cortex M3 core.
1000
1001 @quotation Note
1002 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1003 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1004 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1005 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1006 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1007 @end quotation
1008
1009 @item
1010 You may may need to write some C code.
1011 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1012 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1013 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1014 a new chip architecture.
1015 @end itemize
1016
1017 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1018 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1019 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1020
1021 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1022 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1023 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1024 @itemize
1025
1026 @item
1027 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1028 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1029 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1030 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1031
1032 @item
1033 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1034 @cindex vector_catch
1035 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1036 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1037 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1038 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1039 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1040 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1041
1042 @item
1043 You might need to override some defaults.
1044 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1045 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1046
1047 @item
1048 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1049 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1050 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1051 @end itemize
1052
1053 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1054
1055 A few project-specific utility
1056 routines may well speed up your work.
1057 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1058
1059 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1060 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1061 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1062 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1063 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1064 may help:
1065
1066 @example
1067 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1068 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1069 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1070 # Leave the CPU halted.
1071 reset init
1072
1073 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1074 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1075
1076 # Start running.
1077 resume 0x20000000
1078 @}
1079 @end example
1080
1081 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1082 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1083 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1084 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1085 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1086
1087 @example
1088 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1089 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1090 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1091 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1092 reset init
1093
1094 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1095 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1096 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1097 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1098 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1099 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1100 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1101
1102 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1103 reset run
1104 @}
1105 @end example
1106
1107 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1108 from NAND.
1109 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1110 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1111 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1112
1113 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1114 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1115
1116 @section Target Software Changes
1117
1118 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1119 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1120 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1121 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1122 handling issues like:
1123
1124 @itemize @bullet
1125
1126 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1127 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1128 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1129 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1130 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1131 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1132 your debug sessions.
1133
1134 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1135 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1136 That might however be your only option.
1137
1138 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1139 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1140 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1141 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1142 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1143 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1144 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1145 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1146 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1147 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1148 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1149 instead of the whole thing.
1150 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1151 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1152
1153 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1154 @cindex ARM semihosting
1155 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1156 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1157 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1158 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1159 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1160 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1161 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1162 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1163 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1164 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1165 NAND or SPI flash.
1166
1167 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1168 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1169 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1170 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1171 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1172
1173 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1174 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1175 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1176 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1177 registers which can be used to change various features including
1178 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1179 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1180 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1181 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1182 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1183
1184 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1185 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1186 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1187 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1188 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1189
1190 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1191 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1192 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1193 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1194 early code execution can be debugged
1195 or firmware can be replaced.
1196
1197 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1198 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1199 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1200 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1201 operations like writing to memory.)
1202
1203 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1204 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1205 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1206 various kinds of message.
1207 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1208
1209 @end itemize
1210
1211 @section Target Hardware Setup
1212
1213 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1214 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1215 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1216 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1217 working with.}
1218
1219 Common issues include:
1220
1221 @itemize @bullet
1222
1223 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1224 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1225 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1226 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1227 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1228 or one from a daughtercard).
1229 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1230 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1231
1232 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1233 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1234 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1235 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1236 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1237 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1238
1239 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1240 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1241 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1242 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1243 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1244
1245
1246 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1247 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1248 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1249 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1250 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1251 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1252 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1253
1254 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1255 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1256 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1257 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1258 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1259
1260 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1261 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1262 used to start booting.
1263
1264 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1265 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1266 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1267 multiple audio codec chips).
1268 This interacts with software
1269 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1270 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1271 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1272 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1273 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1274 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1275 audio or video codecs are used.
1276
1277 @end itemize
1278
1279 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1280 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1281 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1282 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1283 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1284 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1285 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1286 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1287 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1288 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1289
1290
1291 @node Config File Guidelines
1292 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1293
1294 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1295 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1296 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1297 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1298
1299 You should find the following directories under
1300 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1301 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1302 @itemize @bullet
1303 @item @file{interface} ...
1304 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1305 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1306 @item @file{board} ...
1307 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1308 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1309
1310 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1311 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1312 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1313 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1314 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1315 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1316 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1317 a CPU and an FPGA.
1318 @item @file{target} ...
1319 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1320 on a chip
1321 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1322 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1323 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1324 the target config file defines all of them.
1325 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1326 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1327 @end itemize
1328
1329 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1330 file may override features in any of the above files by
1331 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1332 commands specific to their situation.
1333
1334 @section Interface Config Files
1335
1336 The user config file
1337 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1338
1339 @example
1340 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1341 @end example
1342
1343 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1344 in use today with OpenOCD.
1345 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1346 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1347
1348 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1349 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1350 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1351 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1352 and need to provide a driver for it.
1353
1354 @section Board Config Files
1355 @cindex config file, board
1356 @cindex board config file
1357
1358 The user config file
1359 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1360
1361 @example
1362 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1363 @end example
1364
1365 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1366 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1367 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1368
1369 @enumerate
1370 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1371 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1372 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1373 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1374 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1375 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1376 @end enumerate
1377
1378 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1379 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1380 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1381 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1382
1383 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1384 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1385 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1386 configuration works.
1387
1388 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1389
1390 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1391 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1392 convention on how to use certain variables.
1393
1394 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1395 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1396 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1397 used at will within a target configuration file.
1398
1399 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1400 for a board with three chips:
1401
1402 @example
1403 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1404 set CHIPNAME network
1405 set ENDIAN big
1406 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1407 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1408 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1409 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1410
1411 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1412 set CHIPNAME video
1413 set ENDIAN little
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1420 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1421 unset ENDIAN
1422 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1423 @end example
1424
1425 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1426 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1427 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1428 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1429 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1430 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1431 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1432 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1433
1434 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1435 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1436 naming collisions.
1437
1438 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1439 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1440 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1441 up other clocks and peripherals.
1442
1443 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1444 @cindex variable names
1445
1446 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1447 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1448 one such chip (as shown above).
1449 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1450 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1451 to promote consistency and
1452 so that board files can override target defaults.
1453
1454 Inputs to target config files include:
1455
1456 @itemize @bullet
1457 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1458 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1459 tap identifier dotted names.
1460 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1461 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1462 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1463 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1464 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1465 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1466 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1467 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1468 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1469 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1470 @end itemize
1471
1472 Outputs from target config files include:
1473
1474 @itemize @bullet
1475 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1476 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1477 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1478 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1479 specific to that board and that target.
1480 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1481 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1482 @end itemize
1483
1484 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1485 @cindex event, reset-init
1486 @cindex reset-init handler
1487
1488 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1489 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1490 fully set up yet.
1491 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1492 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1493 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1494 handler is one of the most important.
1495
1496 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1497 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1498 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1499 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1500 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1501
1502 @quotation Note
1503 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1504 are included here.
1505 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1506 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1507 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1508 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1509 @end quotation
1510
1511 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1512 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1513 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1514 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1515 those as parameters.
1516 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1517 and disabling the watchdog.
1518 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1519 the next developer doing such work.
1520 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1521
1522 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1523 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1524 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1525 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1526
1527 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1528
1529 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1530 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1531 a low JTAG clock rate.
1532 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1533 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1534 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1535 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1536 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1537 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1538 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1539
1540 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1541 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1542 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1543 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1544 which might be less than that.
1545
1546 @quotation Warning
1547 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1548 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1549 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1550 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1551 @end quotation
1552
1553 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1554 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1555 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1556 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1557 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1558 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1559
1560 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1561 @subsection The init_board procedure
1562 @cindex init_board procedure
1563
1564 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1565 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1566 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1567 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1568 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1569 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1570 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1571 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1572 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1573 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1574 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1575 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1576
1577 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1578 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1579
1580 @example
1581 ### board_file.cfg ###
1582
1583 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1584 source [find target/target.cfg]
1585
1586 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1587 # enables fast on-board clock source
1588 # configures the chip to use it
1589 @}
1590
1591 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1592 proc init_board @{@} @{
1593 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1594
1595 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1596 adapter_khz 1
1597 enable_fast_clock
1598 adapter_khz 10000
1599 @}
1600 @}
1601 @end example
1602
1603 @section Target Config Files
1604 @cindex config file, target
1605 @cindex target config file
1606
1607 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1608 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1609 more target config files like this:
1610
1611 @example
1612 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1613 @end example
1614
1615 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1616 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1617 In summary the target files should contain
1618
1619 @enumerate
1620 @item Set defaults
1621 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1622 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1623 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1624 @item On-Chip flash
1625 @end enumerate
1626
1627 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1628 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1629 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1630
1631 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1632 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1633 can talk to the chip.
1634 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1635 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1636 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1637 and other processing engines.
1638
1639 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1640
1641 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1642 letting board config files express environment-specific
1643 differences in how things should be set up.
1644
1645 @example
1646 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1647 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1648 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1649 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1650 @} else @{
1651 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1652 @}
1653
1654 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1655 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1656 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1657 @} else @{
1658 set _ENDIAN little
1659 @}
1660
1661 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1662 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1663 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1664 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1665 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1666 @} else @{
1667 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1668 @}
1669 @end example
1670 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1671
1672 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1673 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1674 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1675
1676 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1677 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1678 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1679
1680 @example
1681 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1682 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1683 @end example
1684
1685 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1686 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1687 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1688 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1689 for taps.
1690
1691 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1692 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1693 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1694 looks (in part) like this:
1695
1696 @example
1697 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1698 @end example
1699
1700 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1701 to source such a config file twice, with different
1702 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1703 it adds a different TAP each time.
1704
1705 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1706 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1707 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1708 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1709
1710 @example
1711 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1712 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1713 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1714 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1715 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1716 @end example
1717
1718 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1719 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1720
1721 @itemize
1722 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1723 plus a JRC to enable them
1724 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1725 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1726 is not currently used)
1727 @end itemize
1728
1729 @subsection Add CPU targets
1730
1731 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1732 GDB and other commands can use it.
1733 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1734 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1735 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1736 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1737
1738 @example
1739 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1740 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1741 @end example
1742
1743 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1744 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1745 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1746 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1747 a work area if you can.
1748 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1749
1750 @example
1751 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1752 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1753 @end example
1754
1755 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1756 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1757 @cindex SMP
1758 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1759
1760 @example
1761 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1762 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1763 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1764 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1765 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1766 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1767 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1768 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1769 @end example
1770 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1771 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1772 @itemize @bullet
1773 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1774 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1775 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1776 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1777 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1778 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1779 @end itemize
1780
1781 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1782 command have been implemented.
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1785 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1786 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1787 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1788 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1789 following example.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 @example
1793 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1794 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1795 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1796 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1797 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1798 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1799 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1800 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1801 > resume
1802 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1803 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1804 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1805 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1806 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1807 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1808 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1809 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1810 @end example
1811
1812
1813 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1814
1815 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1816 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1817 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1818
1819 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1820 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1821 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1822 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1823 both signals.
1824
1825 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1826 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1827 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1828 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1829 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1830 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1831 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1832 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1833 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1834 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1835 not available.)
1836
1837 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1838 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1839 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1840 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1841 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1842 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1843 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1844 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1845
1846 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1847 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1848 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1849 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1850 slower clock than they will use later.
1851 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1852 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1853 than they will use later.
1854 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1855
1856 @quotation Important
1857 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1858 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1859 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1860 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1861 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1862 @end quotation
1863
1864 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1865 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1866 @cindex init_targets procedure
1867
1868 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1869 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1870 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1871 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1872 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1873 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1874 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1875 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1876 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1877
1878 @example
1879 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1880
1881 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1882 # basic initialization procedure ...
1883 @}
1884
1885 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1886 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1887 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1888 @}
1889
1890 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1891
1892 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1893
1894 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1895 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1896 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1897 @}
1898 @end example
1899
1900 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1901 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1902
1903 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1904
1905 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1906 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1907
1908 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1909 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1910 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1911
1912 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1913 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1914 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1915 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1916 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1917 events already assigned.
1918
1919 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1920
1921 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1922 special high speed download features - enable it.
1923
1924 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1925
1926 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1927 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1928 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1929 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1930 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1931 If you are using an external trace port,
1932 configure it in your board config file.
1933 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1934 configure it in your target config file.
1935
1936 @example
1937 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1938 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1939 @end example
1940
1941 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1942
1943 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1944
1945 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1946 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1947 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1948 the TARGET (chip) file.
1949
1950 Examples:
1951 @itemize @bullet
1952 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1953 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1954 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1955 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1956 @end itemize
1957
1958 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1959 @section Translating Configuration Files
1960 @cindex translation
1961 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1962 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1963 Lauterbach, Segger, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1964 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1965 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1966 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1967
1968 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1969 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1970 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1971 convert other scripts later on.
1972
1973 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1974 replace job:
1975
1976 @example
1977 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1978 #
1979 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1980 #
1981 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1982 #
1983 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1984
1985 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1986 global TARGETNAME
1987
1988 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1989
1990 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1992 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1993 @}
1994 @end example
1995
1996
1997
1998 @node Daemon Configuration
1999 @chapter Daemon Configuration
2000 @cindex initialization
2001 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2002 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2003 supported.
2004
2005 @anchor{configurationstage}
2006 @section Configuration Stage
2007 @cindex configuration stage
2008 @cindex config command
2009
2010 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2011 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2012 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2013 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2014 inside startup scripts.
2015
2016 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2017 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2018 which may be issued interactively.
2019 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2020 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2021
2022 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2023 flash banks,
2024 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2025 and other basic setup.
2026 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2027 may access or activate TAPs.
2028 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2029 longer be issued.
2030
2031 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2032 @section Entering the Run Stage
2033
2034 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2035 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2036 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2037 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2038 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2039 You should see no errors at this point.
2040 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2041 commands you used to configure the server.
2042 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2043 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2044 on the scan chain.
2045
2046 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2047 become available.
2048 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2049 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2050 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2051 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2052 entry to the run stage.
2053
2054 @deffn {Config Command} init
2055 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2056 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2057 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2058 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2059 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2060 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2061
2062 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2063 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2064 configuration files and/or command line options.
2065
2066 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2067 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2068 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2069 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2070 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2071 @end deffn
2072
2073 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2074 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2075 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2076
2077 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2078 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2079 scan chain.
2080 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2081 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2082
2083 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2084 they return.
2085 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2086 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2087 @end deffn
2088
2089 @anchor{tcpipports}
2090 @section TCP/IP Ports
2091 @cindex TCP port
2092 @cindex server
2093 @cindex port
2094 @cindex security
2095 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2096 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2097 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2098
2099 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2100 access using one or more of these ports.
2101 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2102 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2103 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2104
2105 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2106 @cindex GDB server
2107 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2108 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2109 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2110 the normal use cases.
2111
2112 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2113 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2114 disables the gdb server.
2115
2116 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2117 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2118
2119 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2120 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2121
2122 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2123 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2124 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2125
2126 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2127 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2128 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2129 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2130 @end deffn
2131
2132 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2133 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2134 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2135 output from the Tcl engine.
2136 Intended as a machine interface.
2137 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2138 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2139
2140 @end deffn
2141
2142 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2143 Specify or query the
2144 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2145 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2146 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2147 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2148 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2152 @section GDB Configuration
2153 @cindex GDB
2154 @cindex GDB configuration
2155 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2156 The ones listed here are static and global.
2157 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2158 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2159
2160 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2161 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2162 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2163 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2164 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2165 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2166 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2167 @end deffn
2168
2169 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2170 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2171 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2172 vFlash packet is received.
2173 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2174 @end deffn
2175
2176 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2177 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2178 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2179 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2180 for flash programming to work.
2181 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2182 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2183 @end deffn
2184
2185 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2186 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2187 by GDB memory read packets.
2188 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2189 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2190 @end deffn
2191
2192 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2193 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2194 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
2195 @end deffn
2196
2197 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2198 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2199
2200 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2201 @end deffn
2202
2203 @anchor{eventpolling}
2204 @section Event Polling
2205
2206 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2207 where significant events can happen at any time.
2208 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2209 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2210 or to GDB.
2211
2212 Examples of such events include:
2213
2214 @itemize
2215 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2216 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2217 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2218 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2219 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2220 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2221 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2222 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2223 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2224 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2225 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2226 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2227 @end itemize
2228
2229 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2230 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2231 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2232 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2233 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2234
2235 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2236 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2237 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2238 to the various active targets.
2239 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2240 which is normally done in the background.
2241
2242 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2243 Poll the current target for its current state.
2244 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2245 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2246 specific information about the current state is printed.
2247 An optional parameter
2248 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2249
2250 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2251 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2252 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2253 @example
2254 > poll
2255 background polling: on
2256 target state: halted
2257 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2258 current mode: Supervisor
2259 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2260 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2261 >
2262 @end example
2263 @end deffn
2264
2265 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2266 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2267 @cindex config file, interface
2268 @cindex interface config file
2269
2270 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2271 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2272 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2273
2274 @quotation Note
2275 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2276 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2277 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2278 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2279 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2280 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2281 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2282 @end quotation
2283
2284 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2285 through commands in an interface configuration
2286 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2287 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2288
2289 @example
2290 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2291 @end example
2292
2293 These commands tell
2294 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2295 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2296
2297 @example
2298 # jlink interface
2299 interface jlink
2300 @end example
2301
2302 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2303
2304
2305 @section Interface Configuration
2306
2307 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2308 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2309 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2310
2311 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2312 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2313 target.
2314 @end deffn
2315
2316 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2317 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2318 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2319 @end deffn
2320 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2321 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2322 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2323 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2324 the hardware can support.
2325 @end deffn
2326
2327
2328
2329 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2330 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2331 @end deffn
2332
2333 @section Interface Drivers
2334
2335 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2336 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2337 available at run time.
2338
2339 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2340 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2341 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2342 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2343
2344 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2345 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2346 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2347 @end deffn
2348
2349 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2350 Displays status of RTCK option.
2351 Optionally sets that option first.
2352 @end deffn
2353 @end deffn
2354
2355 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2356 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2357 This has one driver-specific command:
2358
2359 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2360 Logs some status
2361 @end deffn
2362 @end deffn
2363
2364 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2365 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2366 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2367 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2368 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2369 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2370 @end deffn
2371
2372 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2373 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2374
2375 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2376 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2377 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2378 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2379 @example
2380 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2381 @end example
2382 @end deffn
2383
2384 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2385 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2386 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2387 @end deffn
2388
2389 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2390 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2391 @end deffn
2392 @end deffn
2393
2394 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2395 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2396 @end deffn
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2399 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2403 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2404
2405 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2406 recommended as its replacement.
2407
2408 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2409 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2410
2411 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2412 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2413 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2414 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2415 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2419 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2420 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2421 is connected to the host.
2422 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2423 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2424 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2428 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2429 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2430 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2431 @itemize @minus
2432 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2433 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2434 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2435 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2436 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2437 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2438 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2439 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2440 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2441 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2442 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2443 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2444 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2445 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2446 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2447 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2448 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2449 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2450 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2451 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2452 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2453 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2454 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2455 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2456 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2457 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2458 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2459 @end itemize
2460 @end deffn
2461
2462 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2463 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2464 default values are used.
2465 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2466 @example
2467 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2468 @end example
2469 @end deffn
2470
2471 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2472 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2473 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2474 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2475 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2476 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2477 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2478 @end deffn
2479
2480 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2481 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2482 The default value is 1.
2483 @end deffn
2484
2485 For example, the interface config file for a
2486 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2487
2488 @example
2489 interface ft2232
2490 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2491 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2492 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2493 @end example
2494 @end deffn
2495
2496 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2497 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2498 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2499 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2500 interface driver.
2501
2502 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2503 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2504 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2505
2506 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2507 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2508 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2509
2510 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2511 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2512 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2513 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2514 will be used for their customary purpose.
2515
2516 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2517 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2518 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2519 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2520
2521 @itemize @minus
2522 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2523 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2524 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2525 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2526 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2527 switching data and direction as necessary
2528 @end itemize
2529
2530 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2531 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2534 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2535 default values are used.
2536 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2537 @example
2538 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2539 @end example
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2543 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2544 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2545 during device selection.
2546 @end deffn
2547
2548 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2549 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2550 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2551 is connected to the host.
2552 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2553 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2554 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2555 @end deffn
2556
2557 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2558 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2559 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2563 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2564 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2565 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2566 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2567 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2568 and initially asserted reset signals.
2569 @end deffn
2570
2571 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2572 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2573 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2574 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2575 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2576 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2577 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2578 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2579 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2580
2581 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2582 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2583 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2584 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2585 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2586 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2587
2588 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2589 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2590 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2591 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2592 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2593 are always driven by the FTDI.
2594
2595 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2596 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2597 @var{name}.
2598 @end deffn
2599
2600 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2601 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2602 @itemize @minus
2603 @item @option{0}, drive low
2604 @item @option{1}, drive high
2605 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2606 @end itemize
2607 @end deffn
2608
2609 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2610 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2611 @end deffn
2612
2613 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2614 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2615 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2616 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2617
2618 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2619 processors which are being simulated.
2620
2621 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2622 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2623 sockets instead of TCP.
2624 @end deffn
2625
2626 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2627 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2628 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2629 @end deffn
2630
2631 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2632 something like:
2633
2634 @example
2635 interface remote_bitbang
2636 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2637 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2638 @end example
2639
2640 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2641 named mysocket:
2642
2643 @example
2644 interface remote_bitbang
2645 remote_bitbang_port 0
2646 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2647 @end example
2648 @end deffn
2649
2650 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2651 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2652 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2653 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2656 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2657 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2658 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2659 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2660 @end deffn
2661
2662 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2663 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2664 default values are used.
2665 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2666 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2667 @example
2668 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2669 @end example
2670 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2671 @example
2672 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2673 @end example
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1})
2677 Sets the state of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters (pins 6 and 8 on the
2678 female JTAG header). These pins can be used as SRST and/or TRST provided the
2679 appropriate connections are made on the target board.
2680
2681 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST (as with an AVR board):
2682 @example
2683 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-assert \
2684 "usb_blaster pin6 1; wait 1; usb_blaster pin6 0"
2685 @end example
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2691 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2692 This has one driver-specific command:
2693
2694 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2695 Display either the address of the I/O port
2696 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2697 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2698 This is a write-once setting.
2699 @end deffn
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2703 Segger J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD transports.
2704
2705 @quotation Compatibility Note
2706 Segger released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2707 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2708 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2709 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2710 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2711 target, and Segger firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2712 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2713 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2714 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2715 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2716 @end quotation
2717
2718 @deffn {Command} {jlink caps}
2719 Display the device firmware capabilities.
2720 @end deffn
2721 @deffn {Command} {jlink info}
2722 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2723 @end deffn
2724 @deffn {Command} {jlink hw_jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2725 Set the JTAG protocol version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG protocol version.
2726 @end deffn
2727 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2728 Display the J-Link configuration.
2729 @end deffn
2730 @deffn {Command} {jlink config kickstart} [val]
2731 Set the Kickstart power on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the Kickstart configuration.
2732 @end deffn
2733 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac_address} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2734 Set the MAC address of the J-Link Pro. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2735 @end deffn
2736 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2737 Set the IP configuration of the J-Link Pro, where A.B.C.D is the IP address,
2738 E the bit of the subnet mask and
2739 F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the IP configuration.
2740 @end deffn
2741 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb_address} [@option{0x00} to @option{0x03} or @option{0xff}]
2742 Set the USB address; this will also change the product id. Without argument, show the USB address.
2743 @end deffn
2744 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2745 Reset the current configuration.
2746 @end deffn
2747 @deffn {Command} {jlink config save}
2748 Save the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2749 @end deffn
2750 @deffn {Config} {jlink pid} val
2751 Set the USB PID of the interface. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2752 @end deffn
2753 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} serial-number
2754 Set the @var{serial-number} of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected to the host.
2755 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2756
2757 Note that there may be leading zeros in the @var{serial-number} string
2758 that will not show in the Segger software, but must be specified here.
2759 Debug level 3 output contains serial numbers if there is a mismatch.
2760
2761 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2762 @end deffn
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2766 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2767 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2768 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2769 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2770
2771 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2772 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2773 This is a write-once setting.
2774 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2775
2776 @itemize @minus
2777 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2778 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2779 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2780 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2781 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2782 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2783 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2784 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2785 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2786 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2787 some versions of
2788 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2789 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2790 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2791 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2792 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2793 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2794 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2795 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2796 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2797 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2798 @end itemize
2799 @end deffn
2800
2801 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2802 Display either the address of the I/O port
2803 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2804 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2805 This is a write-once setting.
2806
2807 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2808 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2809 you may encounter a problem.
2810 @end deffn
2811
2812 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2813 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2814 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2815 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2816 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2817 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2818
2819 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2820 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2821 @quotation Tip
2822 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2823 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2824 @example
2825 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2826 > adapter_khz 500
2827 @end example
2828 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2829 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2830 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2831 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2832 large set of samples.
2833 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2834 @example
2835 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2836 @end example
2837 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2838 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2839
2840 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2841 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2842 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2843 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2844 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2845 @end quotation
2846 @end deffn
2847
2848 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2849 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2850 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2851 @end deffn
2852
2853 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2854 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2855
2856 @example
2857 interface parport
2858 parport_port 0x278
2859 parport_cable wiggler
2860 @end example
2861 @end deffn
2862
2863 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2864 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2865 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2866 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2867 @end deffn
2868 @end deffn
2869
2870 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2871 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2872 @end deffn
2873
2874 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2875 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2876 @end deffn
2877
2878 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2879 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2880
2881 @quotation Note
2882 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2883 which are not currently documented here.
2884 @end quotation
2885 @end deffn
2886
2887 @anchor{hla_interface}
2888 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2889 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2890 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2891 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2892
2893 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2894 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2895 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2896 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2897 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2898
2899 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2900 Currently Not Supported.
2901 @end deffn
2902
2903 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2904 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2905 @end deffn
2906
2907 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2908 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2909 @end deffn
2910
2911 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2912 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2913 @end deffn
2914
2915 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2916 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2917 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2918 @end deffn
2919 @end deffn
2920
2921 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2922 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2923 @end deffn
2924
2925 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2926 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2927 @end deffn
2928
2929 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2930 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2931 @end deffn
2932
2933 @quotation Note
2934 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2935 which are not currently documented here.
2936 @end quotation
2937
2938 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2939 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2940 No arguments: print status.
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2944 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2945 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2946
2947 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2948 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2949 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2950 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2951 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2952 configuration on exit.
2953
2954 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2955 pinout.
2956
2957 @end deffn
2958
2959 @section Transport Configuration
2960 @cindex Transport
2961 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
2962 and the debug adapter you are using,
2963 several transports may be available to
2964 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
2965 @deffn Command {transport list}
2966 displays the names of the transports supported by this
2967 version of OpenOCD.
2968 @end deffn
2969
2970 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
2971 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
2972
2973 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
2974 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
2975 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
2976 adapter's driver).
2977
2978 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
2979 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
2980 supported by the debug adapter.
2981
2982 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
2983 transport, if any.
2984 @end deffn
2985
2986 @subsection JTAG Transport
2987 @cindex JTAG
2988 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
2989 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
2990 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
2991 each of which must be explicitly declared.
2992 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
2993 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
2994
2995 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
2996 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
2997 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
2998 hla_jtag}.
2999
3000 @subsection SWD Transport
3001 @cindex SWD
3002 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3003 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3004 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3005 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3006 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3007 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3008 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3009
3010 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3011 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3012 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3013 hla_swd}.
3014
3015 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3016 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3017 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3018 expected to change.
3019 @end deffn
3020 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3021 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3022 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3023 No parameters: displays current settings.
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @subsection SPI Transport
3027 @cindex SPI
3028 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3029 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3030 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3031 solution for flash programming.
3032
3033 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3034 @section JTAG Speed
3035 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3036 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3037 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3038 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3039 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3040 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3041 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3042 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3043 power management software that may be active.
3044
3045 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3046 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3047 target event handler.
3048 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3049 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3050 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3051 sets up those clocks).
3052 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3053 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3054 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3055 in the target config file.
3056 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3057 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3058 config file instead.
3059 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3060 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3061 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3062
3063 @example
3064 jtag_rclk 3000
3065 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3066 @end example
3067
3068 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3069 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3070 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3071 may not be the fastest solution.
3072
3073 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3074 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3075 which support adaptive clocking.
3076
3077 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3078 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3079 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3080 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3081 than the speed specified.
3082
3083 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3084 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3085 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3086 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3087
3088 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3089 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3090 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3091 JTAG clocking after setup.
3092 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3093 If the interface device can not
3094 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3095 @end deffn
3096
3097 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3098 @cindex adaptive clocking
3099 @cindex RTCK
3100 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3101 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3102 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3103 @example
3104 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3105 jtag_rclk 3000
3106 @end example
3107 @end defun
3108
3109 @node Reset Configuration
3110 @chapter Reset Configuration
3111 @cindex Reset Configuration
3112
3113 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3114 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3115 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3116 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3117 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3118 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3119 Please see the various board files for examples.
3120
3121 @quotation Note
3122 To maintainers and integrators:
3123 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3124 Normally the board configuration file
3125 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3126 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3127
3128 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3129 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3130 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3131 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3132 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3133 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3134 @end quotation
3135
3136 @section Types of Reset
3137
3138 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3139 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3140 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3141
3142 @itemize @bullet
3143 @item
3144 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3145 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3146 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3147 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3148 @item
3149 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3150 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3151 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3152 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3153 @item
3154 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3155 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3156 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3157 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3158 @item
3159 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3160 several other types of reset.
3161 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3162 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3163 There may be individual module resets.
3164 @end itemize
3165
3166 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3167 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3168 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3169 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3170 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3171 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3172 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3173 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3174 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3175
3176 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3177 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3178
3179 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3180 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3181 common issues are:
3182
3183 @itemize @bullet
3184
3185 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3186 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3187 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3188 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3189 when either of those signals is not connected.
3190 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3191 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3192 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3193 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3194
3195 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3196 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3197 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3198 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3199
3200 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3201 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3202 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3203 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3204 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3205 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3206 hardware debouncing.
3207 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3208 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3209
3210 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3211 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3212 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3213 to use push/pull output drivers.
3214 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3215 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3216 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3217 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3218
3219 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3220 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3221 issues (not limited to errata).
3222 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3223 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3224 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3225 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3226 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3227 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3228 @end itemize
3229
3230 There can also be other issues.
3231 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3232 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3233 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3234 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3235 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3236 Agreement (NDA).
3237
3238 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3239 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3240 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3241
3242 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3243 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3244
3245 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3246
3247 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3248 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3249 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3250 allowing it to be deasserted.
3251 @end deffn
3252
3253 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3254 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3255 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3256 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3257 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3258 @end deffn
3259
3260 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3261 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3262 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3263 allowing it to be deasserted.
3264 @end deffn
3265
3266 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3267 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3268 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3269 @end deffn
3270
3271 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3272 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3273 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3274 configuration scripts.
3275
3276 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3277 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3278 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3279 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3280 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3281 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3282 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3283 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3284
3285 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3286 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3287 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3288 -- may be specified at a time.
3289 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3290 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3291 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3292 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3293 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3294
3295 @itemize
3296 @item
3297 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3298 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3299 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3300 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3301 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3302
3303 @quotation Tip
3304 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3305 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3306 @end quotation
3307
3308 @item
3309 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3310 signal implementations.
3311 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3312 indicating everything behaves normally.
3313 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3314 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3315 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3316 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3317 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3318 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3319 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3320
3321 @item
3322 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3323 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3324 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3325 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3326 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3327 while SRST is asserted.
3328 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3329 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3330
3331 @item
3332 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3333 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3334 is required to use this option.
3335 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3336 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3337 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3338 be asserted before any target connection.
3339 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3340 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3341 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3342 @end itemize
3343
3344 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3345 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3346 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3347 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3348 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3349
3350 @itemize
3351 @item
3352 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3353 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3354 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3355 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3356
3357 @item
3358 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3359 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3360 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3361 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3362 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3363 @end itemize
3364 @end deffn
3365
3366 @section Custom Reset Handling
3367 @cindex events
3368
3369 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3370 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3371 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3372 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3373 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3374 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3375
3376 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3377 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3378 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3379 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3380 want to reset everything at once.
3381
3382 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3383 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3384 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3385 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3386 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3387 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3388 needs special attention.
3389
3390 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3391 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3392 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3393 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3394 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3395 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3396 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3397 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3398
3399 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3400 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3401 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3402 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3403 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3404
3405 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3406 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3407 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3408 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3409 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3410 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3411 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3412 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3413 or potentially some other value.
3414
3415 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3416 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3417 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3418 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3419 (or their associated targets)
3420 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3421
3422 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3423 they return.
3424 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3425 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3426 @end deffn
3427
3428 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3429 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3430 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3431 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3432 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3433 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3434 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3435 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3436 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3437 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3438 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3439 @end deffn
3440
3441 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3442 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3443 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3444 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3445 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3446 @end deffn
3447
3448
3449 @node TAP Declaration
3450 @chapter TAP Declaration
3451 @cindex TAP declaration
3452 @cindex TAP configuration
3453
3454 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3455 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3456
3457 @itemize @bullet
3458 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3459 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3460 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3461 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3462 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3463 start running that code.
3464 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3465 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3466 and missing connections.
3467 @end itemize
3468
3469 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3470 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3471 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3472 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3473 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3474
3475 @section Scan Chains
3476 @cindex scan chain
3477
3478 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3479 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3480 They also need to be added to
3481 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3482 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3483 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3484 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3485 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3486 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3487 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3488 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3489
3490 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3491 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3492 command, presented in the next chapter.
3493 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3494 debugging targets.)
3495 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3496
3497 @verbatim
3498 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3499 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3500 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3501 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3502 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3503 @end verbatim
3504
3505 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3506 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3507 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3508 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3509 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3510 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3511 until they are told to do so.
3512
3513 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3514 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3515 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3516 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3517
3518 @example
3519 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3520 @end example
3521
3522 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3523 by a given chip.
3524 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3525 and so forth.
3526 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3527 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3528 both inside a single chip and between them.
3529 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3530
3531 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3532 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3533 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3534 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3535 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3536 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3537 includes commands something like this:
3538
3539 @example
3540 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3541 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3542 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3543 @end example
3544
3545 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3546 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3547 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3548
3549 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3550 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3551 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3552 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3553 @example
3554 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3555 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3556 @}
3557 @end example
3558 @end deffn
3559
3560 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3561 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3562 and their status.
3563 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3564 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3565 but systems with a JTAG router can
3566 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3567 @end deffn
3568
3569 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3570 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3571
3572 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3573 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3574
3575 @section TAP Names
3576 @cindex dotted name
3577
3578 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3579 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3580 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3581 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3582 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3583 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3584 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3585 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3586
3587 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3588 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3589 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3590
3591 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3592
3593 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3594 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3595 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3596 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3597
3598 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3599 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3600 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3601 overridable.
3602
3603 @cindex TAP naming convention
3604 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3605 and should follow this convention:
3606
3607 @itemize @bullet
3608 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3609 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3610 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3611 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3612 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3613 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3614 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3615 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3616 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3617 with a single TAP;
3618 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3619 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3620 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3621 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3622 @end itemize
3623
3624 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3625
3626 @itemize @bullet
3627 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3628 @*The length in bits of the
3629 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3630 @end itemize
3631
3632 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3633
3634 @itemize @bullet
3635 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3636 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3637 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3638 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3639 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3640 (the TAP is linked in).
3641 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3642 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3643 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3644 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3645 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3646 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3647 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3648 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3649 values that were found but not included in the list.
3650
3651 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3652 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3653 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3654 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3655 hardware to find these values.
3656 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3657 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3658 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3659 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3660 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3661 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3662 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3663 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3664 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3665 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3666 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3667 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3668 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3669 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3670 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3671 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3672 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3673 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3674 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3675 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3676 @end itemize
3677 @end deffn
3678
3679 @section Other TAP commands
3680
3681 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3682 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3683 At this writing this TAP attribute
3684 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3685 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3686 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3687 See the next section for information about the available events.
3688
3689 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3690 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3691 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3692 @end deffn
3693
3694 @section TAP Events
3695 @cindex events
3696 @cindex TAP events
3697
3698 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3699 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3700 The other applies to debugger targets,
3701 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3702
3703 The TAP events currently defined are:
3704
3705 @itemize @bullet
3706 @item @b{post-reset}
3707 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3708 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3709 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3710 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3711 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3712
3713 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3714 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3715 of any particular target.
3716 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3717 @item @b{setup}
3718 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3719 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3720 @item @b{tap-disable}
3721 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3722 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3723 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3724 @item @b{tap-enable}
3725 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3726 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3727 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3728 @end itemize
3729
3730 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3731 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3732 contents to be accurate), you might:
3733
3734 @example
3735 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3736 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3737 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3738 @}
3739 @end example
3740
3741
3742 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3743 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3744 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3745 @cindex jrc
3746
3747 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3748 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3749 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3750 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3751 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3752
3753 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3754 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3755 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3756 be visible.
3757 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3758 ignores, such as:
3759
3760 @itemize
3761 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3762 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3763 TAPs receive new instructions.
3764 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3765 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3766 @end itemize
3767
3768 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3769 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3770 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3771 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3772
3773 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3774 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3775
3776 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3777 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3778 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3779 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3780 should define TAP event handlers using
3781 code that looks something like this:
3782
3783 @example
3784 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3785 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3786 @}
3787 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3788 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3789 @}
3790 @end example
3791
3792 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3793
3794 @example
3795 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3796 @end example
3797
3798 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3799 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3800 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3801 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3802
3803 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3804 If necessary, disables the tap
3805 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3806 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3807 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3808 and "0" if it is disabled.
3809 @end deffn
3810
3811 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3812 If necessary, enables the tap
3813 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3814 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3815 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3816 and "0" if it is disabled.
3817 @end deffn
3818
3819 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3820 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3821 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3822 and "0" if it is disabled.
3823
3824 @quotation Note
3825 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3826 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3827 @end quotation
3828 @end deffn
3829
3830 @anchor{autoprobing}
3831 @section Autoprobing
3832 @cindex autoprobe
3833 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3834
3835 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3836 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3837 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3838 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3839
3840 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3841 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3842 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3843 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3844 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3845 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3846 right when they come out of reset).
3847
3848 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3849
3850 @example
3851 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3852 reset_config trst_and_srst
3853 jtag_rclk 8
3854 @end example
3855
3856 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3857 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3858
3859 @enumerate
3860 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3861 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3862 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3863 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3864 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3865 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3866 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3867 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3868 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3869 that is discovered.
3870 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3871 register, it will report it.
3872 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3873 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3874 @end enumerate
3875
3876 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3877 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3878 that's a bit more complex:
3879
3880 @example
3881 clock speed 8 kHz
3882 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3883 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3884 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3885 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3886 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3887 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3888 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3889 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3890 @end example
3891
3892 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3893 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3894 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3895 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3896 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3897 and so forth.
3898
3899 @node CPU Configuration
3900 @chapter CPU Configuration
3901 @cindex GDB target
3902
3903 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3904 You can also access these targets without GDB
3905 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3906 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3907 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3908 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3909
3910 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3911 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3912
3913 @section Target List
3914 @cindex target, current
3915 @cindex target, list
3916
3917 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3918 where each member has a name.
3919 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3920 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3921 (plural!) command.
3922 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3923 look like with more than one:
3924 @verbatim
3925 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3926 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3927 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3928 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3929 @end verbatim
3930
3931 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3932 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3933 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3934 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3935 space seen by that current target.
3936 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3937 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3938 are examples; and there are many more.
3939
3940 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3941
3942 @deffn Command {target current}
3943 Returns the name of the current target.
3944 @end deffn
3945
3946 @deffn Command {target names}
3947 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3948 @example
3949 foreach t [target names] @{
3950 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3951 @}
3952 @end example
3953 @end deffn
3954
3955 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
3956 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
3957
3958 @deffn Command targets [name]
3959 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
3960 command names are singular.}
3961
3962 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
3963 targets in a user friendly form.
3964
3965 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
3966 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
3967 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
3968 @end deffn
3969
3970 @section Target CPU Types
3971 @cindex target type
3972 @cindex CPU type
3973
3974 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
3975 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
3976 when calling @command{target create}.
3977 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
3978 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
3979 what kind of debug support it integrates,
3980 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
3981 what core-specific commands may be available
3982 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
3983 and more.
3984
3985 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
3986 since there's a command to list them.
3987
3988 @anchor{targettypes}
3989 @deffn Command {target types}
3990 Lists all supported target types.
3991 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
3992
3993 @itemize @bullet
3994 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
3995 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3996 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
3997 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3998 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
3999 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4000 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4001 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4002 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4003 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4004 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4005 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4006 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4007 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4008 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4009 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4010 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4011 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4012 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4013 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4014 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4015 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4016 @itemize @minus
4017 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @emph{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4018 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @emph{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4019 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @emph{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4020 @end itemize
4021 And two debug interfaces cores:
4022 @itemize @minus
4023 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @emph{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4024 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @emph{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4025 @end itemize
4026 @end itemize
4027 @end deffn
4028
4029 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4030 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4031 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4032 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4033 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4034 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4035 reflect design generations;
4036 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4037 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4038
4039 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4040 @section Target Configuration
4041
4042 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4043 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4044 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4045 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4046 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4047
4048 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4049 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4050 optional parts.
4051 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4052 command, created as part of target creation.
4053
4054 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4055 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4056 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4057 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4058 to be much more board-specific.
4059 The key steps you use might look something like this
4060
4061 @example
4062 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4063 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4064 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4065 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4066 @end example
4067
4068 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4069 on-chip SRAM.
4070 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4071 writes to target memory;
4072 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4073 GDB memory checksumming;
4074 and more.
4075
4076 @quotation Warning
4077 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4078 inaccessible when application code
4079 (such as an operating system)
4080 enables or disables the MMU.
4081 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4082 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4083 easy access to other addresses needed.
4084 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4085 @end quotation
4086
4087 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4088 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4089 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4090 controllers.
4091 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4092 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4093 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4094
4095 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4096 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4097 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4098 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4099 purposes including additional configuration.
4100
4101 @itemize @bullet
4102 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4103 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4104 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4105 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4106
4107 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4108 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4109 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4110 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4111 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4112 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4113 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4114
4115 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4116 @end itemize
4117 @end deffn
4118
4119 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4120 The options accepted by this command may also be
4121 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4122 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4123 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4124
4125 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4126 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4127 and changing its endianness.
4128
4129 @itemize @bullet
4130
4131 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4132 used to access this target.
4133
4134 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4135 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4136
4137 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4138 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4139 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4140 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4141 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4142 same event name assigns only one handler.
4143
4144 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4145 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4146 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4147 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4148 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4149 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4150 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4151
4152 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4153 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4154 or virtual address is being used.
4155
4156 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4157 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4158
4159 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4160 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4161 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4162 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4163 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4164
4165 @anchor{rtostype}
4166 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4167 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4168 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4169 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4170
4171 @end itemize
4172 @end deffn
4173
4174 @section Other $target_name Commands
4175 @cindex object command
4176
4177 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4178 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4179
4180 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4181 Once a button is created a button
4182 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4183 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4184 configure it like this:
4185
4186 @example
4187 # Create
4188 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4189 # Modify
4190 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4191 # Query
4192 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4193 # Report
4194 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4195 @end example
4196
4197 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4198 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4199
4200 @example
4201 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4202 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4203 @end example
4204
4205 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4206
4207 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4208 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4209 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4210 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4211 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4212 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4213 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4214 They are not otherwise documented here.
4215 @end deffn
4216
4217 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4218 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4219 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4220 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4221 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4222 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4223 the target side uses raw memory.
4224
4225 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4226 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4227 The script orientation comes from working with data
4228 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4229 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4230 and neither store nor return those values.
4231
4232 @itemize
4233 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4234 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4235 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4236 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4237 @end itemize
4238 @end deffn
4239
4240 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4241 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4242 @command{$target_name configure}
4243 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4244 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4245 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4246 There are a few special cases:
4247
4248 @itemize @bullet
4249 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4250 event named @var{event_name}.
4251 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4252 two parameters.
4253 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4254 This is a special case because this is set using
4255 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4256 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4257 @end itemize
4258
4259 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4260 all the targets you might use something like this:
4261
4262 @example
4263 foreach name [target names] @{
4264 set y [$name cget -endian]
4265 set z [$name cget -type]
4266 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4267 $x $name $y $z]
4268 @}
4269 @end example
4270 @end deffn
4271
4272 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4273 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4274 Displays the current target state:
4275 @code{debug-running},
4276 @code{halted},
4277 @code{reset},
4278 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4279 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4280 @end deffn
4281
4282 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4283 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4284 currently associated with this target.
4285 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4286 @end deffn
4287
4288 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4289 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4290 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4291 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4292 @end deffn
4293
4294 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4295 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4296 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4297 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4298 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4299 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4300 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4301 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4302 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4303 @end deffn
4304
4305 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4306 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4307 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4308 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4309 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4310 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4311 @end deffn
4312
4313 @anchor{targetevents}
4314 @section Target Events
4315 @cindex target events
4316 @cindex events
4317 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4318 For example:
4319 @itemize @bullet
4320 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4321 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4322 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4323 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4324 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4325 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4326 to set up system clocks or
4327 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4328 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4329 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4330 @end itemize
4331
4332 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4333 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4334 @command{target create ... -event}.
4335
4336 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4337 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4338 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4339
4340 @example
4341 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4342 echo "Reset..."
4343 reset halt
4344 @}
4345 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4346 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4347 echo "Reset..."
4348 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work we need a reset init.
4349 reset init
4350 @}
4351 @end example
4352
4353 The following target events are defined:
4354
4355 @itemize @bullet
4356 @item @b{debug-halted}
4357 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4358 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4359 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4360 @item @b{early-halted}
4361 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4362 @item @b{examine-start}
4363 @* Before target examine is called.
4364 @item @b{examine-end}
4365 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4366 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4367 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4368 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4369 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4370 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4371 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4372 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4373 @* When GDB disconnects
4374 @item @b{gdb-end}
4375 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4376 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4377 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4378 @code{reset init})
4379 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4380 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4381 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4382 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4383 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4384 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4385 @item @b{gdb-start}
4386 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4387 @item @b{halted}
4388 @* The target has halted
4389 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4390 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4391 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4392 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4393 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4394 @item @b{reset-assert}
4395 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4396 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4397 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4398 it instead of asserting SRST.
4399 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4400 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4401 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4402 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4403 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4404 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4405 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4406 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4407 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4408 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4409 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4410 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4411 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4412 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4413 released on the scan chain.
4414 @item @b{reset-end}
4415 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4416 @ignore
4417 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4418 @* Currently not used
4419 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4420 @* Currently not used
4421 @end ignore
4422 @item @b{reset-init}
4423 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4424 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4425
4426 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4427 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4428 multiplexing, and so on.
4429 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4430 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4431 @item @b{reset-start}
4432 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4433 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4434
4435 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4436 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4437 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4438 @ignore
4439 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4440 @* Currently not used
4441 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4442 @* Currently not used
4443 @end ignore
4444 @item @b{resume-start}
4445 @* Before any target is resumed
4446 @item @b{resume-end}
4447 @* After all targets have resumed
4448 @item @b{resumed}
4449 @* Target has resumed
4450 @item @b{trace-config}
4451 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4452 @end itemize
4453
4454 @node Flash Commands
4455 @chapter Flash Commands
4456
4457 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4458 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4459 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4460 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4461 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4462 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4463 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4464 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4465 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4466
4467 Flash Steps:
4468 @enumerate
4469 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4470 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4471 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4472 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4473 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4474 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4475 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4476 @item GDB Flashing
4477 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4478 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4479 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4480 @end enumerate
4481
4482 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4483 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4484 so that it can't boot.
4485 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4486 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4487
4488 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4489 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4490 @cindex flash configuration
4491
4492 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4493 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4494 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4495 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4496 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4497 see the driver-specific documentation.
4498
4499 @itemize @bullet
4500 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4501 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4502 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4503 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4504 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4505 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4506 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4507 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4508 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4509 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4510 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4511 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4512 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4513 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4514 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4515 commands to the flash controller.
4516 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4517 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4518 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4519 for more information.
4520 @end itemize
4521 @quotation Note
4522 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4523 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4524 @end quotation
4525 @end deffn
4526
4527 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4528 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4529 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4530 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4531 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4532 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4533 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4534 @end deffn
4535
4536 @deffn Command {flash list}
4537 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4538 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4539 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4540 @end deffn
4541
4542 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4543 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4544 depends on the flash type.
4545 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4546 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4547 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4548 but most don't bother.
4549 @end deffn
4550
4551 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4552 @cindex flash erasing
4553 @cindex flash reading
4554 @cindex flash writing
4555 @cindex flash programming
4556 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4557
4558 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4559 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4560 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4561 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4562 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4563
4564 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4565 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4566 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4567 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4568 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4569
4570 @quotation Note
4571 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4572 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4573 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4574 back to a flash bank.
4575 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4576 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4577 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4578 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4579 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4580 @end quotation
4581
4582 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4583 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4584 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4585 disabled first.
4586 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4587 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4588 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4589
4590 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4591 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4592 up to and including @var{last}.
4593 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4594 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4595 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4596 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4597 @end deffn
4598
4599 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4600 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4601 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4602 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4603 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4604 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4605 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4606 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4607 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4608 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4609 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4610 before erase starts.
4611 @end deffn
4612
4613 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4614 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4615 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4616 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4617 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4618 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4619 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4620 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4621 before issuing this command.
4622 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4623 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4624 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4625 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4626 @end deffn
4627 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4628
4629 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4630 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4631 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4632 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4633 @end deffn
4634
4635 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4636 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4637 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4638 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4639 to the base address for each section in the image.
4640 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4641 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4642 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4643 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4644 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4645 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4646 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4647 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4648 each image section.
4649
4650 @quotation Warning
4651 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4652 data you want to preserve.
4653 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4654 sections might be erased with no notice.
4655 @itemize
4656 @item
4657 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4658 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4659 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4660 @item
4661 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4662 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4663 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4664 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4665 @end itemize
4666 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4667 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4668 @end quotation
4669
4670 @end deffn
4671
4672 @section Other Flash commands
4673 @cindex flash protection
4674
4675 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4676 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4677 and display that status.
4678 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4679 @end deffn
4680
4681 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4682 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4683 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4684 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4685 and possibly stale information.
4686 @end deffn
4687
4688 @anchor{flashprotect}
4689 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4690 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4691 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4692 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4693 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4694 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4695 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4696 @end deffn
4697
4698 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4699 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4700 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4701 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4702 @end deffn
4703
4704 @anchor{program}
4705 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4706 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4707 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4708 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4709 @end deffn
4710
4711 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4712 @section Flash Driver List
4713 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4714 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4715 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4716
4717 @subsection External Flash
4718
4719 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4720 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4721 @cindex CFI
4722 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4723 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4724 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4725 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4726 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4727 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4728 configure a bus and its timings), or
4729 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4730 on the flash chip.
4731 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4732 speed up operation.
4733
4734 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4735
4736 @itemize
4737 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4738 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4739 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4740 @end itemize
4741
4742 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4743 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4744
4745 @example
4746 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4747 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4748 @end example
4749
4750 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4751 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4752 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4753
4754 @example
4755 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4756 @end example
4757
4758 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4759 @end deffn
4760
4761 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4762 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4763 @cindex SPIFI
4764 @cindex lpcspifi
4765 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4766 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4767 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4768
4769 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4770 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4771 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4772 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4773 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4774
4775 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4776 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4777 are configured by the driver.
4778
4779 @example
4780 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4781 @end example
4782
4783 @end deffn
4784
4785 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4786 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4787 @cindex SMI
4788 @cindex stmsmi
4789 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4790 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4791 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4792 SPI flash devices.
4793 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4794 flash devices can be connected.
4795
4796 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4797 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4798 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4799 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4800 the flash content.
4801
4802 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4803 to identify the memory bank.
4804 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4805 flash size, are detected automatically.
4806
4807 @example
4808 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4809 @end example
4810
4811 @end deffn
4812
4813 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4814
4815 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4816 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4817 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4818 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4819 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4820 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4821
4822 @example
4823 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4824 @end example
4825 @end deffn
4826
4827 @anchor{at91samd}
4828 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4829 @cindex at91samd
4830
4831 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4832 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4833 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4834 processor to be halted.
4835 @end deffn
4836
4837 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4838 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4839 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4840 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4841 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4842 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4843
4844 @example
4845 at91samd set-security enable
4846 @end example
4847 @end deffn
4848
4849 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
4850 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
4851 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
4852 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
4853 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
4854 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
4855 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
4856 in order to disable this feature.
4857
4858 @example
4859 at91samd eeprom
4860 at91samd eeprom 1024
4861 @end example
4862 @end deffn
4863
4864 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
4865 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
4866 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
4867 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
4868 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
4869 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
4870
4871 @example
4872 at91samd bootloader
4873 at91samd bootloader 16384
4874 @end example
4875 @end deffn
4876
4877 @end deffn
4878
4879 @anchor{at91sam3}
4880 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
4881 @cindex at91sam3
4882 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
4883 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
4884 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
4885 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
4886 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
4887 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
4888 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
4889 chips are confirmed.}
4890
4891 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
4892 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
4893 the following fixed locations:
4894
4895 @example
4896 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
4897 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
4898 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
4899 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
4900 @end example
4901
4902 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
4903 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
4904 to the @command{flash bank} command:
4905
4906 @itemize
4907 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
4908 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
4909 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
4910 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
4911 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
4912 @end itemize
4913
4914 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
4915
4916 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
4917 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
4918 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
4919 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
4920 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
4921 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
4922 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
4923
4924 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
4925 modifies that GPNVM bit.
4926 @end deffn
4927
4928 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
4929 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
4930 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
4931 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
4932 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
4933 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
4934 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
4935 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
4936 @end deffn
4937
4938 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
4939 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
4940 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
4941 @end deffn
4942 @end deffn
4943
4944 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
4945 @cindex at91sam4
4946 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
4947 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4948 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4949 @end deffn
4950
4951 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
4952 @cindex at91sam4l
4953 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
4954 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4955 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4956
4957 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
4958 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
4959 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
4960 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
4961 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
4962 @end deffn
4963 @end deffn
4964
4965 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
4966 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
4967 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
4968 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
4969 register, and autoconfigures itself.
4970
4971 @example
4972 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4973 @end example
4974
4975 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
4976 provide additional parameters in the following order:
4977
4978 @itemize
4979 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
4980 @item @var{banks}
4981 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
4982 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
4983 @item @var{pages_size}
4984 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
4985 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
4986 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
4987 @end itemize
4988
4989 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
4990 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
4991 will be autoconfigured.
4992 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
4993
4994 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
4995 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
4996 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
4997 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
4998 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
4999
5000 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5001 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5002 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5003 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5004 are not truly general purpose).
5005 @quotation Note
5006 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5007 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5008 @end quotation
5009 @end deffn
5010 @end deffn
5011
5012 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5013 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5014 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5015 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5016 @end deffn
5017
5018 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5019 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5020 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5021 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5022 autoconfigures itself.
5023 @example
5024 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5025 @end example
5026 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5027 supported.}
5028 @end deffn
5029
5030 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5031 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5032 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5033 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5034 microcontroller families from NXP.
5035
5036 @quotation Note
5037 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5038 driver:
5039 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5040 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5041 @end quotation
5042
5043 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5044 which must appear in the following order:
5045
5046 @itemize
5047 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5048 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5049 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5050 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5051 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5052 LPC43x[2357])
5053 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5054 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5055 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5056 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5057 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5058 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5059 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5060 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5061 at which the core is running
5062 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5063 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5064 @quotation Note
5065 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5066 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5067 However, if you do provide it,
5068 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5069 @end quotation
5070 @end itemize
5071
5072 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5073
5074 @example
5075 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5076 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5077 @end example
5078
5079 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5080 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5081 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5082 @end deffn
5083 @end deffn
5084
5085 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5086 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5087 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5088 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5089 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5090 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5091
5092 @example
5093 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5094 @end example
5095 @end deffn
5096
5097 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5098 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5099 from NXP.
5100
5101 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5102 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5103 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5104 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5105 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5106 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5107 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5108 you start the PLL.
5109
5110 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5111
5112 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5113 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5114 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5115
5116 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5117 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5118 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5119 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5120 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5121 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5122 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5123
5124 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5125 @example
5126 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5127 @end example
5128
5129 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5130 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5131 @code{flash banks} command.
5132
5133 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5134 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5135 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5136 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5137 a known signature.
5138 Example:
5139 @example
5140 lpc2900 signature 0
5141 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5142 @end example
5143 @end deffn
5144
5145 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5146 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5147 saves it to a file in binary format.
5148 Example:
5149 @example
5150 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5151 @end example
5152 @end deffn
5153
5154 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5155 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5156 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5157 command:
5158
5159 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5160 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5161 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5162 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5163
5164 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5165 Example:
5166 @example
5167 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5168 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5169 @end example
5170 @end deffn
5171
5172 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5173 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5174 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5175 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5176 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5177 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5178 912 bytes.
5179 @quotation Attention
5180 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5181 @end quotation
5182 Example:
5183 @example
5184 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5185 @end example
5186 @end deffn
5187
5188 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5189 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5190 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5191 after the next power cycle.
5192 @quotation Attention
5193 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5194 @end quotation
5195 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5196 Example:
5197 @example
5198 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5199 flash info 0
5200 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5201 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5202 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5203 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5204 @end example
5205 @end deffn
5206
5207 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5208 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5209 effective after the next power cycle.
5210 @quotation Attention
5211 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5212 @end quotation
5213 Examples:
5214 @example
5215 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5216 @end example
5217 @end deffn
5218 @end deffn
5219
5220 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5221 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5222 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5223
5224 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5225 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5226 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5227 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5228
5229 @example
5230 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5231 @end example
5232 @end deffn
5233
5234 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5235 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5236 and integrate flash memory.
5237
5238 @example
5239 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5240 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5241 @end example
5242
5243 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5244 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5245 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5246 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5247 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5248 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5249 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5250 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5251 @end deffn
5252 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5253 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5254 This will remove any Code Protection.
5255 @end deffn
5256 @end deffn
5257
5258 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5259 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5260 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0 cores.
5261 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5262 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5263
5264 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5265 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5266
5267 @example
5268 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5269 @end example
5270
5271 psoc4-specific commands
5272 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5273 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5274
5275 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5276 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5277
5278 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5279 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5280 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5281
5282 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5283 @end deffn
5284
5285 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5286 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5287
5288 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5289 @end deffn
5290 @end deffn
5291
5292 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5293 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5294 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5295 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5296 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5297 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5298 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5299 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5300
5301 @example
5302 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5303 @end example
5304
5305 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5306 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5307 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5308 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5309 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5310 disabled.
5311
5312 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5313 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5314 @quotation Warning
5315 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5316 applied to all of them.
5317 @end quotation
5318 @end deffn
5319 @end deffn
5320
5321 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5322 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5323 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5324 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5325 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5326
5327 @example
5328 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5329 @end example
5330
5331 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5332 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5333 the flash driver.
5334
5335 @example
5336 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5337 @end example
5338
5339 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5340 as per the following example.
5341 @example
5342 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5343 @end example
5344
5345 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5346 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5347 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5348 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5349 are defined:
5350
5351 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5352 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5353 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5354 @end deffn
5355
5356 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5357 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5358 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5359 @end deffn
5360
5361 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5362 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5363 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5364 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5365 @end deffn
5366
5367 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5368 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5369 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5370 @end deffn
5371 @end deffn
5372
5373 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5374 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5375 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5376 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5377 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5378
5379 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5380 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5381 the flash driver.
5382
5383 @example
5384 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5385 @end example
5386
5387 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5388
5389 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5390 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5391 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5392 @end deffn
5393
5394 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5395 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5396 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5397 @end deffn
5398 @end deffn
5399
5400 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5401 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5402 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5403 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5404 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5405
5406 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5407 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5408 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5409 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5410 second bank.
5411
5412 @example
5413 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5414 @end example
5415
5416 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5417
5418 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5419 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5420 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5421 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5422 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5423 @end deffn
5424 @end deffn
5425
5426 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5427 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5428 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5429 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5430 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5431
5432 @example
5433 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5434 @end example
5435
5436 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5437 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5438 for the specified flash bank.
5439 @end deffn
5440 @end deffn
5441
5442 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5443 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5444 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5445 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5446 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5447
5448 @example
5449 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5450 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5451 @end example
5452
5453 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5454 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5455 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5456
5457 @itemize @bullet
5458 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5459 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5460 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5461 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5462 @end itemize
5463 @end deffn
5464
5465 @end deffn
5466
5467 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5468 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5469 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5470 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5471
5472 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5473
5474 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5475 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5476 @end deffn
5477
5478 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5479 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5480 @end deffn
5481
5482 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5483 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5484 the flash clock.
5485 @end deffn
5486 @end deffn
5487
5488 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5489 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5490 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5491
5492 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5493
5494 @itemize
5495 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5496 @end itemize
5497
5498 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5499 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
5500 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
5501 @example
5502 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5503 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5504 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5505 @end example
5506 @end deffn
5507
5508 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5509 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5510 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5511 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5512 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5513 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5514 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5515
5516 @example
5517 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5518 @end example
5519 @end deffn
5520
5521 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5522 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5523 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5524 and SWD interface.
5525 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5526 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5527
5528 @example
5529 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5530 @end example
5531
5532 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5533
5534 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5535 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5536 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5537 @end deffn
5538
5539 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5540 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5541 @end deffn
5542
5543 @end deffn
5544
5545 @subsection str9xpec driver
5546 @cindex str9xpec
5547
5548 Here is some background info to help
5549 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5550 the str9:
5551 @enumerate
5552 @item
5553 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5554 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5555 @item
5556 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5557 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5558 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5559 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5560 @end enumerate
5561
5562 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5563 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5564 configured for flash bank 0.
5565 @example
5566 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5567 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5568 jtag_reset 0 1
5569 # turn off target polling
5570 poll off
5571 # disable str9 core
5572 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5573 # read option bytes
5574 str9xpec options_read 0
5575 # re-enable str9 core
5576 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5577 poll on
5578 reset halt
5579 @end example
5580 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5581 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5582 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5583 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5584
5585 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5586 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5587 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5588 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5589 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5590
5591 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5592
5593 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5594 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5595 @end deffn
5596
5597 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5598 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5599 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5600 @end deffn
5601
5602 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5603 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5604 erase the device.
5605 @end deffn
5606
5607 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5608 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5609 @end deffn
5610
5611 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5612 Configure str9 boot bank.
5613 @end deffn
5614
5615 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5616 Configure str9 lvd source.
5617 @end deffn
5618
5619 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5620 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5621 @end deffn
5622
5623 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5624 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5625 @end deffn
5626
5627 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5628 Read str9 option bytes.
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5632 Write str9 option bytes.
5633 @end deffn
5634
5635 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5636 unlock str9 device.
5637 @end deffn
5638
5639 @end deffn
5640
5641 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5642 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5643 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5644
5645 @example
5646 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5647 @end example
5648
5649 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5650
5651 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5652 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5653 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5654 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5655 code.
5656 @end deffn
5657
5658 @end deffn
5659
5660 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5661 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5662 Microcontroller platform.
5663
5664 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5665 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5666
5667 @example
5668 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5669 @end example
5670
5671 @end deffn
5672
5673 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5674 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5675 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5676 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5677
5678 @example
5679 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5680 @end example
5681
5682 @itemize @bullet
5683 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5684 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5685 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5686 @end itemize
5687
5688 Example usage:
5689 @example
5690 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5691 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5692 @} else @{
5693 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5694 @}
5695 @end example
5696 @end deffn
5697
5698 @section mFlash
5699
5700 @subsection mFlash Configuration
5701 @cindex mFlash Configuration
5702
5703 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
5704 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
5705 address @var{base}.
5706 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
5707 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
5708
5709 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
5710
5711 @example
5712 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
5713 @end example
5714
5715 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
5716
5717 @example
5718 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
5719 @end example
5720 @end deffn
5721
5722 @subsection mFlash commands
5723 @cindex mFlash commands
5724
5725 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
5726 Configure mflash PLL.
5727 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
5728 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
5729 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
5730 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
5731 @end deffn
5732
5733 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
5734 Configure bootable option.
5735 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
5736 (4kB) for boot.
5737 @end deffn
5738
5739 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
5740 Configure storage information.
5741 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
5742 written.
5743 @end deffn
5744
5745 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
5746 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
5747 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
5748 @end deffn
5749
5750 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
5751 Probe mflash.
5752 @end deffn
5753
5754 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
5755 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
5756 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
5757 @end deffn
5758
5759 @node Flash Programming
5760 @chapter Flash Programming
5761
5762 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
5763 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5764 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5765
5766 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
5767 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
5768
5769 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
5770 @enumerate
5771 @item 'init' is executed.
5772 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
5773 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
5774 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
5775 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
5776 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
5777 @end enumerate
5778
5779 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
5780
5781 @example
5782 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
5783 # are optional parameters
5784 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
5785 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
5786
5787 # binary files need the flash address passing
5788 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
5789 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
5790 @end example
5791
5792 @node NAND Flash Commands
5793 @chapter NAND Flash Commands
5794 @cindex NAND
5795
5796 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
5797 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
5798 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
5799
5800 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
5801 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
5802 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
5803 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
5804 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
5805 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
5806
5807 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
5808 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
5809 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
5810 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
5811 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
5812 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
5813 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
5814 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
5815 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
5816 with techniques such as wear leveling.
5817
5818 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
5819 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
5820 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
5821 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
5822 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
5823 every 512 bytes of data.
5824
5825 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
5826 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
5827 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
5828 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
5829 ECC mode is used.
5830
5831 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
5832 @enumerate
5833 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
5834 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5835 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
5836 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
5837 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
5838 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
5839 to access that device.
5840 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
5841 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5842 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
5843 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
5844 de-brick a board.
5845 @end enumerate
5846
5847 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
5848 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
5849 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
5850 are only 32 bits wide.
5851 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
5852 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
5853 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
5854 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
5855
5856 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
5857 @section NAND Configuration Commands
5858 @cindex NAND configuration
5859
5860 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
5861 plus some additional configuration that's done after
5862 OpenOCD has initialized.
5863
5864 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
5865 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
5866 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
5867 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
5868 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
5869 they were a single (larger) device.
5870 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
5871 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
5872
5873 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
5874 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
5875 configuration files, not interactively.
5876
5877 @itemize @bullet
5878 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
5879 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
5880 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
5881 associated with the NAND device being declared.
5882 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
5883 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
5884 commands to the NAND controller.
5885 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5886 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
5887 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
5888 for more information.
5889 @end itemize
5890 @end deffn
5891
5892 @deffn Command {nand list}
5893 Prints a summary of each device declared
5894 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
5895 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
5896 @example
5897 > nand list
5898 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5899 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5900 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5901 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5902 >
5903 @end example
5904 @end deffn
5905
5906 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
5907 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
5908 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
5909 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5910 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
5911 it with most other NAND commands.
5912 @end deffn
5913
5914 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
5915
5916 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
5917 @cindex NAND reading
5918 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
5919 starting at the specified offset.
5920 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5921
5922 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5923 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5924
5925 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
5926 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
5927 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
5928
5929 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
5930 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
5931 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
5932 method which handled that error correction.
5933
5934 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
5935 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
5936 @itemize @bullet
5937 @item no oob_* parameter
5938 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
5939 @item @code{oob_raw}
5940 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
5941 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
5942 spare areas associated with each data page.
5943 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
5944 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
5945 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
5946 @item @code{oob_only}
5947 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
5948 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
5949 spare areas associated with each data page.
5950 @end itemize
5951 @end deffn
5952
5953 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
5954 @cindex NAND erasing
5955 @cindex NAND programming
5956 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
5957 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
5958 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
5959 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
5960 If those parameters are not specified,
5961 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
5962 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5963
5964 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
5965 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
5966 block marker.
5967 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
5968 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
5969 @end deffn
5970
5971 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
5972 @cindex NAND writing
5973 @cindex NAND programming
5974 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
5975 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
5976 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
5977 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5978
5979 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5980 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5981
5982 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
5983 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
5984 past the end of the device.
5985 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
5986 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
5987 if that's being written.)
5988
5989 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
5990 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
5991 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
5992
5993 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
5994 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
5995 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
5996 @itemize @bullet
5997 @item no oob_* parameter
5998 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5999 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6000 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6001 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6002 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6003 @item @code{oob_only}
6004 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6005 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6006 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6007 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6008 @item @code{oob_raw}
6009 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6010 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6011 un-altered OOB.
6012 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6013 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6014 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6015 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6016 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6017 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6018 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6019 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6020 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6021 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6022 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6023 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6024 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6025 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6026 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6027 @end itemize
6028 @end deffn
6029
6030 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6031 @cindex NAND verification
6032 @cindex NAND programming
6033 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6034 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6035 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6036
6037 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6038 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6039
6040 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6041 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6042 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6043 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6044 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6045
6046 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6047 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6048 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6049
6050 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6051 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6052 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6053 be removed in a future release.
6054 @end deffn
6055
6056 @section Other NAND commands
6057 @cindex NAND other commands
6058
6059 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6060 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6061 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6062 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6063 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6064 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6065 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6066 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6067
6068 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6069 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6070 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6071 @end deffn
6072
6073 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6074 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6075 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6076 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6077 status for each block.
6078 @end deffn
6079
6080 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6081 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6082 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6083
6084 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6085 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6086 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6087 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6088 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6089
6090 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6091 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6092 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6093 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6094 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6095 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6096 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6097 @end deffn
6098
6099 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6100 @section NAND Driver List
6101 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6102 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6103 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6104
6105 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6106 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6107 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6108 address of the ECC controller.
6109 @example
6110 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6111 @end example
6112 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6113 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6114 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6115 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6116 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6117 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6118 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6119 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6120 @end deffn
6121 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6122 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6123 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6124 @end deffn
6125
6126 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6127 properly configured for input or output.
6128 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6129 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6130 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6131 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6132 @end deffn
6133 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6134 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6135 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6136 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6137 @end deffn
6138 @end deffn
6139
6140 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6141 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6142 chips from Texas Instruments.
6143 It takes three extra parameters:
6144 address of the NAND chip;
6145 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6146 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6147 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6148 @example
6149 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6150 @end example
6151 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6152 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6153 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6154 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6155 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6156 @end deffn
6157
6158 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6159 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6160 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6161 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6162 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6163 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6164 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6165 @end deffn
6166
6167 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6168 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6169 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6170 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6171 @end deffn
6172 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6173
6174 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6175 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6176 should work for this chip aswell.
6177 @end deffn
6178
6179 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6180 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6181 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6182 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6183 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6184 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6185 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6186 @example
6187 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6188 @end example
6189 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6190 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6191 without parameter query status.
6192 @end deffn
6193 @end deffn
6194
6195 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6196 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6197 parameter: the address of the controller.
6198 @example
6199 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6200 @end example
6201 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6202 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6203 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6204 change any behavior.
6205 @end deffn
6206
6207 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6208 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6209 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6210 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6211 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6212 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6213 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6214 specialized commands.
6215 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6216 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6217 change any behavior.
6218 @end deffn
6219
6220 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6221 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6222 @cindex PLD
6223 @cindex FPGA
6224
6225 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6226 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6227 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6228 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6229 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6230 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6231 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6232
6233 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6234
6235 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6236 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6237 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6238
6239 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6240 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6241
6242 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6243 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6244 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6245 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6246 behavior.
6247 @end deffn
6248
6249 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6250 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6251 @end deffn
6252
6253 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6254 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6255 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6256 @end deffn
6257
6258 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6259
6260 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6261 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6262 that particular type of PLD.
6263
6264 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2
6265 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6266 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6267 No driver-specific PLD definition options are used,
6268 and one driver-specific command is defined.
6269
6270 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6271 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6272 for FPGA @var{num}.
6273 @end deffn
6274 @end deffn
6275
6276 @node General Commands
6277 @chapter General Commands
6278 @cindex commands
6279
6280 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6281 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6282 commands are documented elsewhere.
6283
6284 Intent:
6285 @itemize @bullet
6286 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6287 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6288 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6289 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6290
6291 @item @b{From the human}
6292 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6293 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6294
6295 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6296 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6297 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6298
6299 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6300 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6301 port is 5555.
6302 @end itemize
6303
6304
6305 @section Daemon Commands
6306
6307 @deffn {Command} exit
6308 Exits the current telnet session.
6309 @end deffn
6310
6311 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6312 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6313 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6314 Not every command provides helptext.
6315
6316 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6317 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6318 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6319 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6320 @end deffn
6321
6322 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6323 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6324 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6325 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6326 Useful in connection with script files
6327 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6328 @end deffn
6329
6330 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6331 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6332 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6333 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6334 @end deffn
6335
6336 @anchor{debuglevel}
6337 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6338 @cindex message level
6339 Display debug level.
6340 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6341 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6342 Level 0 is error messages only;
6343 level 1 adds warnings;
6344 level 2 adds informational messages;
6345 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6346 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6347 the command line along with the location of that log
6348 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6349 @xref{Running}.
6350 @end deffn
6351
6352 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6353 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6354 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6355 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6356 @example
6357 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6358 @end example
6359 @end deffn
6360
6361 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6362 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6363 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6364 @end deffn
6365
6366 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6367 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6368 @end deffn
6369
6370 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6371 @section Target State handling
6372 @cindex reset
6373 @cindex halt
6374 @cindex target initialization
6375
6376 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6377 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6378 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6379 a current target which is used to perform the
6380 various operations. The current target may be changed
6381 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6382 target which should become current.
6383
6384 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6385 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6386 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6387 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6388 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6389
6390 @emph{With no arguments}:
6391 list all available registers for the current target,
6392 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6393 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6394 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6395 are flagged as such.
6396
6397 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6398 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6399 bypassing any internal cache.
6400
6401 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6402 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6403 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6404 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6405 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6406 relevant module will flush such values.
6407
6408 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6409 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6410
6411 @example
6412 > reg
6413 ===== ARM registers
6414 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6415 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6416 (2) r2 (/32)
6417 ...
6418 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6419 >
6420 @end example
6421 @end deffn
6422
6423 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6424 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6425 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6426 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6427 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6428 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6429 (and enter debug mode).
6430 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6431
6432 @quotation Warning
6433 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6434 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6435 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6436 power mode by gating the core clock;
6437 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6438
6439 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6440 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6441 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6442 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6443 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6444 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6445
6446 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6447 work with a JTAG debugger.
6448 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6449 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6450 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6451 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6452 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6453 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6454 @end quotation
6455
6456 @end deffn
6457
6458 @deffn Command resume [address]
6459 Resume the target at its current code position,
6460 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6461 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6462 @end deffn
6463
6464 @deffn Command step [address]
6465 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6466 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6467 @end deffn
6468
6469 @anchor{resetcommand}
6470 @deffn Command reset
6471 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6472 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6473 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6474 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6475 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6476 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6477
6478 The optional parameter specifies what should
6479 happen after the reset.
6480 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6481 The other options will not work on all systems.
6482 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6483
6484 @itemize @minus
6485 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6486 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6487 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6488 @end itemize
6489 @end deffn
6490
6491 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6492 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6493 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6494 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6495 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6496 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6497 state.
6498 @end deffn
6499
6500 @section I/O Utilities
6501
6502 These commands are available when
6503 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6504 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6505 notably the ZY1000.
6506 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6507
6508 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6509
6510 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6511 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6512 the text file @file{filename}.
6513 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6514 The last string is followed by a newline.
6515 @end deffn
6516
6517 @deffn Command cat filename
6518 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6519 @end deffn
6520
6521 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6522 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6523 into @file{dest_filename}.
6524 @end deffn
6525
6526 @deffn Command ip
6527 @emph{No description provided.}
6528 @end deffn
6529
6530 @deffn Command ls
6531 @emph{No description provided.}
6532 @end deffn
6533
6534 @deffn Command mac
6535 @emph{No description provided.}
6536 @end deffn
6537
6538 @deffn Command meminfo
6539 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6540 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6541 @end deffn
6542
6543 @deffn Command peek
6544 @emph{No description provided.}
6545 @end deffn
6546
6547 @deffn Command poke
6548 @emph{No description provided.}
6549 @end deffn
6550
6551 @deffn Command rm filename
6552 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6553 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6554 @end deffn
6555
6556 @deffn Command trunc filename
6557 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6558 @end deffn
6559
6560 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6561 @section Memory access commands
6562 @cindex memory access
6563
6564 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6565 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6566 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6567 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6568
6569 @enumerate
6570 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6571 to change the current target.
6572 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6573 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6574 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6575 @end enumerate
6576
6577 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6578 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6579 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6580 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6581 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6582 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6583 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6584 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6585 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6586 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6587 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6588 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6589 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6590 @end deffn
6591
6592 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6593 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6594 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6595 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6596 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6597 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6598 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6599 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6600 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6601 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6602 @end deffn
6603
6604 @anchor{imageaccess}
6605 @section Image loading commands
6606 @cindex image loading
6607 @cindex image dumping
6608
6609 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6610 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6611 binary file named @var{filename}.
6612 @end deffn
6613
6614 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6615 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6616 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6617 @end deffn
6618
6619 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6620 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6621 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6622 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6623 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6624 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6625 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6626 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6627 separately.
6628 @end deffn
6629
6630 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6631 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6632 The file format may optionally be specified
6633 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6634 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6635 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6636 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6637 @example
6638 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6639 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6640 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6641 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin $address $length
6642 @}
6643 @end example
6644 @end deffn
6645
6646 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6647 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6648 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6649 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6650 The file format may optionally be specified
6651 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6652 @end deffn
6653
6654 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6655 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6656 The file format may optionally be specified
6657 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6658 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6659 @end deffn
6660
6661
6662 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6663 @cindex breakpoint
6664 @cindex watchpoint
6665
6666 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6667 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6668 watchpoints.
6669 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6670
6671 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6672 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6673 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
6674 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6675 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
6676 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
6677
6678 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
6679 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
6680 @end deffn
6681
6682 @deffn Command {rbp} address
6683 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
6684 @end deffn
6685
6686 @deffn Command {rwp} address
6687 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
6688 @end deffn
6689
6690 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
6691 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
6692 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6693 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
6694 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
6695 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
6696 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
6697 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
6698 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
6699 @end deffn
6700
6701 @section Misc Commands
6702
6703 @cindex profiling
6704 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
6705 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
6706 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
6707 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
6708 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
6709 limit the address range.
6710 @end deffn
6711
6712 @deffn Command {version}
6713 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
6714 @end deffn
6715
6716 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
6717 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
6718 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
6719 @end deffn
6720
6721 @node Architecture and Core Commands
6722 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
6723 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
6724 @cindex Core Specific Commands
6725
6726 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
6727 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
6728 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
6729 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
6730
6731 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
6732 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
6733 @cindex tracing
6734 @cindex ETM
6735 @cindex ETB
6736
6737 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
6738 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
6739 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
6740
6741 @itemize
6742 @item
6743 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
6744 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
6745 supports such an interface.
6746 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
6747 and trace port support.)
6748 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
6749 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
6750 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
6751 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
6752 in the board-specific configuration file.
6753 @item
6754 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
6755 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
6756 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
6757 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
6758 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
6759 @end itemize
6760
6761 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
6762
6763 @quotation Issues
6764 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
6765 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
6766
6767 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
6768 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
6769 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
6770 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
6771 dummy trace port driver}.
6772
6773 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
6774 as well as tracing only during specific states
6775 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
6776
6777 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
6778 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
6779 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
6780 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
6781 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
6782
6783 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
6784 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
6785 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
6786 this original style of JTAG access.
6787 @end quotation
6788
6789 @subsection ETM Configuration
6790 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
6791
6792 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
6793 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
6794 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
6795
6796 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
6797 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
6798 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
6799 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
6800 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
6801 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
6802 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
6803 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
6804 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
6805
6806 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
6807 or @option{demultiplexed}.
6808 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
6809
6810 @quotation Warning
6811 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
6812 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
6813 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
6814 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
6815 @end quotation
6816
6817 @quotation Note
6818 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
6819 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
6820 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
6821 what CPU activities are traced.
6822 @end quotation
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @deffn Command {etm info}
6826 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
6827 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
6828 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
6829 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
6830 @end deffn
6831
6832 @deffn Command {etm status}
6833 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
6834 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
6835 Did trace data overflow?
6836 Was it triggered?
6837 @end deffn
6838
6839 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
6840 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
6841 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
6842 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
6843 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
6844
6845 @itemize
6846 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
6847 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
6848 The value is one of
6849 @option{none} (save nothing),
6850 @option{data} (save data),
6851 @option{address} (save addresses),
6852 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
6853 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
6854 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
6855 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
6856 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
6857 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
6858 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
6859 trace stream without an image of the code.
6860 @end itemize
6861 @end deffn
6862
6863 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6864 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
6865 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
6866 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
6867 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
6868
6869 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
6870 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
6871 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
6872 @end deffn
6873
6874 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
6875
6876 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
6877 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
6878 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
6879
6880 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
6881 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
6882 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
6883 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
6884 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
6885 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
6886 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
6887
6888 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
6889
6890 @itemize
6891 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
6892 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
6893 for instruction access within that function's body.
6894 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
6895 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
6896 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
6897 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
6898 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
6899 combining one of the above models with a counter.
6900 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
6901 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
6902 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
6903 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
6904 @item @emph{... more}
6905 @end itemize
6906
6907 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
6908 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
6909
6910 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
6911 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
6912 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
6913 @end deffn
6914
6915 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
6916 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
6917 @end deffn
6918
6919 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
6920 Opens an image file.
6921 @end deffn
6922
6923 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
6924 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
6925 @end deffn
6926
6927 @deffn Command {etm start}
6928 Starts trace data collection.
6929 @end deffn
6930
6931 @deffn Command {etm stop}
6932 Stops trace data collection.
6933 @end deffn
6934
6935 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
6936 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
6937
6938 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
6939
6940 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
6941 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
6942 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
6943 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
6944 any trace data collection.}
6945 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
6946 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
6947 @end deffn
6948 @end deffn
6949
6950 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
6951 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
6952 to use on-chip ETB memory.
6953 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
6954 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
6955 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
6956 @end deffn
6957 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
6958 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
6959 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
6960 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
6961 trace trigger becomes active.
6962
6963 @itemize
6964 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
6965 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
6966 afterwards.
6967 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
6968 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
6969 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
6970 what caused that event to happen.
6971 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
6972 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
6973 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
6974 how the event caused trouble.
6975 @end itemize
6976 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
6977 @end deffn
6978
6979 @end deffn
6980
6981 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
6982 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
6983 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
6984 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
6985 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
6986
6987 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
6988 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
6989
6990 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
6991 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
6992 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
6993 @end deffn
6994
6995 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
6996 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
6997 @end deffn
6998
6999 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7000 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7001 @end deffn
7002 @end deffn
7003
7004
7005 @section Generic ARM
7006 @cindex ARM
7007
7008 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7009 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7010 commands that may be available.
7011
7012 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7013 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7014 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7015 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7016 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7017 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7018 @end deffn
7019
7020 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7021 @cindex disassemble
7022 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7023 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7024 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7025 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7026 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7027 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7028 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7029
7030 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7031 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7032 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7033 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7034 with a handful of exceptions.
7035 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7036 @end deffn
7037
7038 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7039 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7040 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7041 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7042 and using the MCR instruction.
7043 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7044 an ARM register.)
7045 @end deffn
7046
7047 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7048 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7049 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7050 and the MRC instruction.
7051 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7052 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7053 an ARM register.)
7054 @end deffn
7055
7056 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7057 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7058 core mode if necessary.
7059 @end deffn
7060
7061 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7062 @cindex ARM semihosting
7063 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7064
7065 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7066 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7067 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7068 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7069 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7070 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7071 @end deffn
7072
7073 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7074 @cindex ARMv4
7075 @cindex ARMv5
7076
7077 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7078 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7079 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7080 variant.
7081
7082 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7083 @cindex ARM7
7084 @cindex ARM9
7085
7086 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7087 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7088 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7089 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7090
7091 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7092 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7093 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7094 instead of breakpoints.
7095 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7096
7097 This should be
7098 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7099 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7100 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7101 @end deffn
7102
7103 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7104 @cindex DCC
7105 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7106 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7107 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7108
7109 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7110 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7111 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7112 @end deffn
7113
7114 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7115 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7116 that don't check completion of the operation.
7117 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7118
7119 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7120 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7121 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7122 @end deffn
7123
7124 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7125 @cindex ARM720T
7126
7127 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7128 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7129 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7130 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7131
7132 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7133 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7134 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7135
7136 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7137 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7138 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7139 @end deffn
7140
7141 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7142 @cindex ARM9
7143
7144 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7145 integer processors.
7146 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7147
7148 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7149 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7150 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7151 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7152
7153 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7154 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7155 @cindex vector_catch
7156 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7157 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7158 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7159 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7160 to those hardware vectors.
7161
7162 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7163 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7164 vector catch hardware to intercept
7165 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7166 @option{none} of them,
7167 or a list with one or more of the following:
7168 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7169 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7170 @end deffn
7171
7172 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7173 @cindex ARM920T
7174
7175 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7176 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7177 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7178 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7179 and ARM9 commands.
7180
7181 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7182 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7183 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7184 @end deffn
7185
7186 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7187 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7188 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7189 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7190 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7191 (Not all registers can be written.)
7192 @end deffn
7193
7194 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7195 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7196 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7197
7198 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7199 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7200 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7201 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7202 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7203 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7204 @end deffn
7205
7206 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7207 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7208 @end deffn
7209
7210 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7211 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7215 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7216
7217 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7218 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7219 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7220 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7221 and ARM9 commands.
7222
7223 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7224 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7225
7226 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7227 Print information about the caches found.
7228 @end deffn
7229
7230 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7231 @cindex ARM966E
7232
7233 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7234 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7235 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7236 and ARM9 commands.
7237
7238 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7239 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7240 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7241 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7242 ARM966E-S TRM.
7243 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7244 as required for BIST support.
7245 @end deffn
7246
7247 @subsection XScale specific commands
7248 @cindex XScale
7249
7250 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7251
7252 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7253 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7254 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7255 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7256 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7257 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7258 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7259
7260 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7261 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7262 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7263 the mini-IC.
7264
7265 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7266 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7267 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7268 code layout in memory:
7269 @example
7270 _vectors:
7271 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7272 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7273 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7274 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7275 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7276 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7277 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7278 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7279 .org 0x100
7280 .long real_reset_vector
7281 .long real_ui_handler
7282 .long real_swi_handler
7283 .long real_pf_abort
7284 .long real_data_abort
7285 .long 0 /* unused */
7286 .long real_irq_handler
7287 .long real_fiq_handler
7288 @end example
7289
7290 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7291 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7292 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7293 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7294 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7295 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7296 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7297 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7298 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7299 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7300 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7301 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7302 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7303 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7304 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7305 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7306 software.
7307
7308 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7309 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7310 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7311 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7312
7313 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7314 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7315 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7316 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7317 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7318 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7319 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7320 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7321 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7322
7323 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7324 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7325
7326 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7327 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7328 @end deffn
7329
7330 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7331 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7332 @end deffn
7333
7334 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7335 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7336 @end deffn
7337
7338 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7339 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7340 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7341 @end deffn
7342
7343 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7344 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7345 @end deffn
7346
7347 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7348 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7349 @end deffn
7350
7351 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7352 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7353 @end deffn
7354
7355 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7356 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7357 @end deffn
7358
7359 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7360 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7361 @end deffn
7362
7363 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7364 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7365 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7366 and modifying how it is emptied.
7367 @end deffn
7368
7369 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7370 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7371 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7372 The image @var{type} may be one of
7373 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7374 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7375 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7376 @end deffn
7377
7378 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7379 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7380 @cindex vector_catch
7381 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7382 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7383
7384 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7385 @example
7386 0x01 Trap Reset
7387 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7388 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7389 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7390 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7391 0x20 reserved
7392 0x40 Trap IRQ
7393 0x80 Trap FIQ
7394 @end example
7395 @end deffn
7396
7397 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7398 @cindex vector_table
7399
7400 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7401 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7402 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7403 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7404 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7405
7406 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7407
7408 @end deffn
7409
7410 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7411 @cindex ARMv6
7412
7413 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7414 @cindex ARM11
7415
7416 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7417 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7418 which is enabled by default.
7419 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7420 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7421 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7422 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7423 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7424 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7425 @end deffn
7426
7427 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7428 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7429 which is enabled by default.
7430 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7431 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7432 @end deffn
7433
7434 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7435 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7436 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7437 they are disabled by default.
7438 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7439 @end deffn
7440
7441 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7442 @cindex vector_catch
7443 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7444 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7445 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7446
7447 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7448 for certain hardware events.
7449 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7450 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7451 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7452 @end deffn
7453
7454 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7455 @cindex ARMv7
7456
7457 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7458 @cindex Debug Access Port
7459 @cindex DAP
7460 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7461 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7462 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7463
7464 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7465 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7466 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7467 @end deffn
7468
7469 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7470 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7471 @end deffn
7472
7473 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7474 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7475 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7476 @end deffn
7477
7478 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7479 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7480 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7481 @end deffn
7482
7483 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7484 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7485 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7486 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7487 @end deffn
7488
7489 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7490 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7491 Defaulting to 0.
7492 @end deffn
7493
7494 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7495 @cindex tracing
7496 @cindex SWO
7497 @cindex SWV
7498 @cindex TPIU
7499 @cindex ITM
7500 @cindex ETM
7501
7502 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal @var{filename}}) @
7503 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7504 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7505
7506 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7507 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7508 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7509 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7510
7511 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7512 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7513 debugger adapter features.
7514
7515 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7516 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7517
7518 Command options:
7519 @itemize @minus
7520 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7521 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7522 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7523 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7524 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7525 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7526 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7527 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7528 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7529 coding;
7530 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7531 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7532 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7533 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7534 data is to be output via SWO;
7535 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7536 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7537 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7538 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7539 rate automatically.
7540 @end itemize
7541
7542 Example usage:
7543 @enumerate
7544 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7545 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7546 enough to:
7547 @example
7548 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7549 ...
7550 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7551 ...
7552 @end example
7553 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7554 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7555 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7556 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7557 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7558 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7559 @example
7560 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7561 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7562 @end example
7563 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7564 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7565 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7566 @item @code{openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg -c "transport select
7567 hla_swd" -f target/stm32l1.cfg -c "tpiu config external uart off
7568 24000000 12000000"}
7569 @end enumerate
7570 @end deffn
7571
7572 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7573 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
7574 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
7575 @end deffn
7576
7577 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7578 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
7579 @end deffn
7580
7581 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7582 @cindex Cortex-M
7583
7584 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7585 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7586
7587 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7588 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7589 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7590 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7591 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7592 the step command leaves with the core running.
7593
7594 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7595 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7596 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7597
7598 Default is @option{auto}.
7599 @end deffn
7600
7601 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7602 @cindex vector_catch
7603 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7604 for certain hardware events.
7605
7606 Parameters request interception of
7607 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
7608 @option{none} of them,
7609 or one or more of the following:
7610 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
7611 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
7612 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
7613 @option{irq_err},
7614 @option{state_err},
7615 @option{chk_err}, or
7616 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
7617 @option{reset}.
7618 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
7619 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
7620 are mapped to HardFault.
7621 UsageFault checks for
7622 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
7623 must also be explicitly enabled.
7624
7625 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
7626 @end deffn
7627
7628 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
7629 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
7630 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7631 @itemize @minus
7632 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7633 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
7634 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
7635 @end itemize
7636 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
7637 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
7638 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
7639 the peripherals.
7640 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
7641 @end deffn
7642
7643 @section Intel Architecture
7644
7645 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
7646 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
7647 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
7648 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
7649 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
7650 @itemize
7651 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
7652 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
7653 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
7654 @end itemize
7655
7656 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
7657 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
7658 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
7659
7660 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
7661 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7662 @end deffn
7663
7664 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
7665 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7666 @end deffn
7667
7668 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
7669 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7670 @end deffn
7671
7672 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
7673 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7674 @end deffn
7675
7676 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
7677 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7678 @end deffn
7679
7680 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
7681 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7682 @end deffn
7683
7684 @section OpenRISC Architecture
7685
7686 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
7687 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
7688
7689 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
7690 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
7691 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
7692 @end deffn
7693 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
7694 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
7695
7696 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
7697
7698 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
7699 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
7700 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
7701 @end deffn
7702
7703 @subsection Registers commands
7704 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
7705 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
7706 included in the generated target descriptor file.
7707
7708 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
7709
7710 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
7711 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
7712 and "timer" groups.
7713
7714 @emph{example:}
7715 @example
7716 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
7717 @end example
7718
7719
7720 @end deffn
7721 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
7722 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
7723
7724 @emph{group} can be "system",
7725 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
7726 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
7727 @end deffn
7728
7729 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
7730 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
7731 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
7732 @cindex tracing
7733 @cindex libdcc
7734 @cindex DCC
7735 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
7736 the target uses appropriate libraries.
7737 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
7738 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
7739
7740 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
7741 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
7742 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
7743 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
7744 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
7745 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
7746
7747 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
7748 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
7749 arrays of various size integers from the target,
7750 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
7751 The target being debugged may
7752 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
7753 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
7754 each supported by a command:
7755
7756 @itemize
7757 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
7758 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
7759 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
7760 finding out how some fault was triggered.
7761
7762 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
7763 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
7764 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
7765
7766 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
7767 and then displayed at any time.
7768 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
7769
7770 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
7771 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
7772 @end itemize
7773
7774 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
7775 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
7776 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
7777 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
7778 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
7779 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
7780 does the same thing.
7781
7782 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
7783 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
7784 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
7785 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
7786 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
7787
7788 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
7789 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
7790 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
7791 @end deffn
7792
7793 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
7794 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
7795 in the order they triggered.
7796 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
7797 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
7798 history records.
7799 @end deffn
7800
7801 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
7802 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
7803 they have been triggered.
7804 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
7805 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
7806 and associates it with that identifier.
7807
7808 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
7809 are not related except by this command.
7810 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
7811 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
7812 @end deffn
7813
7814
7815 @node JTAG Commands
7816 @chapter JTAG Commands
7817 @cindex JTAG Commands
7818 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
7819 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
7820 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
7821 may be needed to work with targets which require special
7822 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
7823
7824 To use these commands you will need to understand some
7825 of the basics of JTAG, including:
7826
7827 @itemize @bullet
7828 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
7829 devices such as a CPUs.
7830 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
7831 standard state machine (in parallel)
7832 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
7833 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
7834 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
7835 while the reading previous ones.
7836 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
7837 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
7838 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
7839 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
7840 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
7841 registers.
7842 @end itemize
7843
7844 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
7845
7846 These commands are used by developers who need to access
7847 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
7848 the order of TAP state transitions.
7849 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
7850 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
7851 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
7852 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
7853 these commands are not available.
7854
7855 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7856 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
7857 that specify the entire register.
7858 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
7859 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
7860 The return value holds the original value of each
7861 of those fields.
7862
7863 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
7864 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
7865 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
7866 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
7867 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
7868
7869 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
7870 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
7871
7872 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7873 in that state.
7874 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
7875 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7876 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7877
7878 @quotation Warning
7879 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
7880 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
7881 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
7882 data registers, which may have different lengths.
7883 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
7884 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
7885 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
7886 (by connecting a different scan chain).
7887 @end quotation
7888 @end deffn
7889
7890 @deffn Command {flush_count}
7891 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
7892 This may be used for performance tuning.
7893
7894 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
7895 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
7896 not change with the amount of data which is written.
7897 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
7898 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
7899 instead of batching them into larger operations.
7900 @end deffn
7901
7902 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7903 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
7904 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
7905 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
7906 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
7907 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
7908
7909 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7910 in that state.
7911 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
7912 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7913 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7914
7915 @quotation Note
7916 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
7917 register values, unlike data register values.
7918 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
7919 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
7920 @end quotation
7921 @end deffn
7922
7923 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
7924 Set values of reset signals.
7925 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
7926 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
7927 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
7928 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7929 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
7930 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7931 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7932
7933 Note that TRST is specially handled.
7934 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7935 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7936 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7937 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7938 instead of the TRST signal.
7939 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7940 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7941 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7942 with handlers for that event.
7943 @end deffn
7944
7945 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
7946 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
7947 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
7948 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
7949 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
7950 Then, in a series of single state transitions
7951 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
7952 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
7953 The final state must also be stable.
7954 @end deffn
7955
7956 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
7957 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
7958 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
7959 Instructions often need some time
7960 to execute before they take effect.
7961 @end deffn
7962
7963 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
7964 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
7965
7966 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7967 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
7968 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
7969 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
7970 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
7971 @end deffn
7972
7973 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7974 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
7975 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
7976 must also be enabled.
7977 Default is enabled.
7978 @end deffn
7979
7980 @section TAP state names
7981 @cindex TAP state names
7982
7983 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
7984 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
7985 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
7986 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
7987
7988 @itemize @bullet
7989 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
7990 acts as if TRST were pulsed
7991 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
7992 @item @b{DRSELECT}
7993 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
7994 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
7995 through the data register
7996 @item @b{DREXIT1}
7997 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
7998 for update or more shifting
7999 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8000 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8001 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8002 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8003 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8004 through the instruction register
8005 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8006 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8007 for update or more shifting
8008 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8009 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8010 @end itemize
8011
8012 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8013 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8014 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8015 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8016
8017 @itemize @bullet
8018 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8019 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8020 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8021 may not be as expected.
8022 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8023 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8024 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8025 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8026 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8027 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8028 @end itemize
8029
8030 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8031 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8032
8033 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8034 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8035 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8036 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8037
8038 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8039 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8040 @cindex SVF
8041
8042 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8043 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8044 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8045 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8046
8047 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8048 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8049 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8050 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8051 each command is logged before it is executed.
8052 @end deffn
8053
8054 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8055 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8056 @cindex XSVF
8057
8058 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8059 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8060 Xilinx devices.
8061 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8062 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8063
8064 @quotation Important
8065 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8066 @end quotation
8067
8068 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8069 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8070 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8071 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8072 that TAP.
8073 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8074 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8075 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8076 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8077 @end deffn
8078
8079 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8080 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8081 after building the software.
8082 You may find them useful:
8083
8084 @itemize
8085 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8086 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8087 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8088 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8089 @end itemize
8090
8091 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8092 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8093 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8094 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8095 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8096 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8097 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8098
8099
8100 @node Utility Commands
8101 @chapter Utility Commands
8102 @cindex Utility Commands
8103
8104 @section RAM testing
8105 @cindex RAM testing
8106
8107 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8108 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8109 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8110 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8111 hardware problems.
8112
8113 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8114 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8115 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8116 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8117
8118 Load the memory testing functions with
8119
8120 @example
8121 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8122 @end example
8123
8124 to get access to the following facilities:
8125
8126 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8127 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8128 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8129 @end deffn
8130
8131 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8132 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8133 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8134 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8135 @end deffn
8136
8137 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8138 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8139 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8140 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8141 @end deffn
8142
8143 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8144 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8145 @end deffn
8146
8147 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8148 @cindex Firmware recovery
8149
8150 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8151 devices recovery with JTAG.
8152
8153 For quickstart instructions run:
8154 @example
8155 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8156 @end example
8157
8158 @node TFTP
8159 @chapter TFTP
8160 @cindex TFTP
8161 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8162 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8163
8164 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8165 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8166 server (tftpd). For example,
8167
8168 @example
8169 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8170 @end example
8171
8172 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8173 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8174
8175 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8176 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8177 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8178 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8179
8180 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8181 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8182 @cindex GDB
8183 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8184 to debug remote targets.
8185 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8186
8187 @itemize
8188 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8189 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8190 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8191 as shown in this chapter.
8192 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8193 that also will probably need to be configured.
8194 @end itemize
8195
8196 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8197 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8198 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8199 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8200 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8201 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8202
8203 @section Connecting to GDB
8204 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8205 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8206 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8207 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8208 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8209
8210 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8211
8212 @enumerate
8213 @item
8214 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8215 @example
8216 target remote localhost:3333
8217 @end example
8218 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8219
8220 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8221 @example
8222 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8223 @end example
8224 @item
8225 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8226 @example
8227 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8228 @end example
8229 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8230 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8231 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8232 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8233 @end enumerate
8234
8235 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8236 GDB command line.
8237
8238 @section Sample GDB session startup
8239
8240 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8241 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8242 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8243 small ARM program.
8244 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8245 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8246
8247 @example
8248 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8249 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8250 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8251 ...
8252 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8253 ...
8254 (gdb) load
8255 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8256 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8257 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8258 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8259 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8260 (gdb) continue
8261 Continuing.
8262 ...
8263 @end example
8264
8265 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8266 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8267 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8268 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8269
8270 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8271
8272 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8273 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8274 packet size and the device's memory map.
8275 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8276 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8277 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8278
8279 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8280 You may need to set those up by hand.
8281 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8282 something like:
8283
8284 @example
8285 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8286 @end example
8287
8288 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8289
8290 @example
8291 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8292 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8293 @end example
8294
8295 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8296 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8297 do not have such restrictions.
8298
8299 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8300 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8301 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8302
8303 @example
8304 define hook-step
8305 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8306 end
8307 define hookpost-step
8308 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8309 end
8310 @end example
8311
8312 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8313 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8314 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8315 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8316
8317 @section Programming using GDB
8318 @cindex Programming using GDB
8319 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8320
8321 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8322 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8323 @example
8324 gdb_memory_map disable
8325 @end example
8326 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8327 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8328 working area.
8329
8330 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8331 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8332 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8333 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8334
8335 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8336 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8337
8338 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8339 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8340 @example
8341 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8342 @end example
8343
8344 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8345 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8346
8347 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8348 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8349 will be used.
8350
8351 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8352 script can be executed:
8353 @example
8354 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8355 @end example
8356
8357 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8358 can be used.
8359 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8360 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8361 @cindex SMP
8362 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8363 @itemize @bullet
8364 @item j - smp status request
8365 @item J - smp set request
8366 @end itemize
8367
8368 OpenOCD implements :
8369 @itemize @bullet
8370 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8371 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8372 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8373 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8374 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8375 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8376 @end itemize
8377
8378 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8379 @itemize @bullet
8380 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8381 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8382 @example
8383 set $_core 1
8384 #Jc01 packet is sent
8385 print $_core
8386 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8387 @end example
8388
8389 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8390 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8391
8392 @example
8393 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8394 define toggle0
8395 maint packet Jc0
8396 continue
8397 main packet Jc-1
8398 end
8399 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8400 define toggle1
8401 maint packet Jc1
8402 continue
8403 main packet Jc-1
8404 end
8405 @end example
8406 @end itemize
8407
8408 @section RTOS Support
8409 @cindex RTOS Support
8410 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8411
8412 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8413 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8414
8415 @* An example setup is below:
8416
8417 @example
8418 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8419 @end example
8420
8421 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8422
8423 Currently supported rtos's include:
8424 @itemize @bullet
8425 @item @option{eCos}
8426 @item @option{ThreadX}
8427 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8428 @item @option{linux}
8429 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8430 @item @option{embKernel}
8431 @item @option{mqx}
8432 @end itemize
8433
8434 @quotation Note
8435 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8436 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8437 @end quotation
8438
8439 @table @code
8440 @item eCos symbols
8441 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8442 @item ThreadX symbols
8443 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8444 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8445 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8446 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8447 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8448 @item linux symbols
8449 init_task.
8450 @item ChibiOS symbols
8451 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8452 @item embKernel symbols
8453 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8454 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8455 @item mqx symbols
8456 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8457 @end table
8458
8459 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8460 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8461
8462 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8463 along with the project:
8464
8465 @table @code
8466 @item FreeRTOS
8467 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8468 @end table
8469
8470 @node Tcl Scripting API
8471 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8472 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8473 @cindex Tcl scripts
8474 @section API rules
8475
8476 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8477 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8478 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8479
8480 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8481 pair list and lists.
8482
8483 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8484 list.
8485
8486 @example
8487 > set foo(me) Duane
8488 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8489 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8490 > set foo(duck) Donald
8491 @end example
8492
8493 If one does this:
8494
8495 @example
8496 > set foo
8497 @end example
8498
8499 The result is:
8500
8501 @example
8502 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8503 @end example
8504
8505 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8506
8507 @verbatim
8508 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8509 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8510 }
8511 @end verbatim
8512
8513 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8514 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8515
8516 @section Internal low-level Commands
8517
8518 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8519 invoke directly.
8520
8521 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8522 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8523 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8524
8525 @itemize @bullet
8526 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8527
8528 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8529 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8530
8531 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8532 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8533
8534 Return information about the flash banks
8535
8536 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8537
8538 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8539 its execution. Example:
8540
8541 @example
8542 > capture "reset init"
8543 @end example
8544
8545 @end itemize
8546
8547 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8548 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8549 called "flash_banks".
8550
8551 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8552
8553 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8554 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8555 holds one of the following values:
8556
8557 @itemize @bullet
8558 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8559 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8560 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8561 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8562 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8563 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8564 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8565 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8566 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8567 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8568 @end itemize
8569
8570 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8571
8572 @quotation Note
8573 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8574 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8575 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8576 is jim, not real tcl).
8577 @end quotation
8578
8579 @section Tcl RPC server
8580 @cindex RPC
8581
8582 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8583 commands and receive the results.
8584
8585 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8586 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8587 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8588 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8589 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8590
8591 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8592 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8593 @command{capture} command.
8594
8595 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
8596
8597 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
8598 @cindex RPC Notifications
8599
8600 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8601 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8602
8603 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
8604 in the following format.
8605
8606 @verbatim
8607 type target_event event [event-name]
8608 type target_state state [state-name]
8609 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
8610 @end verbatim
8611
8612 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
8613 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
8614 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8615 Defaults to off.
8616
8617 @end deffn
8618
8619 @node FAQ
8620 @chapter FAQ
8621 @cindex faq
8622 @enumerate
8623 @anchor{faqrtck}
8624 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
8625 @cindex RTCK
8626 @cindex adaptive clocking
8627 @*
8628
8629 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
8630 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
8631 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
8632 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
8633
8634 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
8635 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
8636 for example. There are 2 basic options:
8637 @enumerate
8638 @item
8639 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
8640 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
8641 @item
8642 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
8643 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
8644 @end enumerate
8645
8646 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
8647 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
8648 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
8649 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
8650 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
8651 power).
8652
8653 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
8654 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
8655 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
8656 ARM926 scenario).
8657 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
8658 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
8659 JTAG can use a faster clock.
8660
8661 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
8662 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
8663 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
8664 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
8665
8666 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
8667
8668 In order to make use of this,
8669 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
8670 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
8671
8672 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
8673 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
8674 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
8675 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
8676 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
8677
8678 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
8679 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
8680 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
8681 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
8682
8683 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
8684 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
8685 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
8686 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
8687 with a CPLD.
8688 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
8689 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
8690 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
8691 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
8692 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
8693 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
8694
8695 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
8696
8697 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
8698
8699 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
8700 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
8701 depending on the chips on your board.
8702 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
8703 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
8704 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
8705
8706 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
8707 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
8708 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
8709
8710 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
8711 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
8712 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
8713 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
8714
8715 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
8716 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
8717 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
8718 this way.
8719
8720 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
8721 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
8722 clock rate.
8723 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
8724 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
8725 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8726
8727 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
8728
8729 @example
8730 # Example: 1.234MHz
8731 adapter_khz 1234
8732 @end example
8733
8734
8735 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
8736
8737 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
8738 around Windows filenames.
8739
8740 @example
8741 > echo \a
8742
8743 > echo @{\a@}
8744 \a
8745 > echo "\a"
8746
8747 >
8748 @end example
8749
8750
8751 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
8752
8753 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
8754 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
8755 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
8756
8757 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
8758 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
8759 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
8760
8761 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
8762 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
8763 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
8764
8765 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
8766
8767 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
8768 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
8769 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
8770 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
8771
8772 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
8773 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
8774 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
8775
8776 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
8777 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
8778
8779 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
8780 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
8781 memory read caused data abort".
8782
8783 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
8784 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
8785 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
8786 be done, feel free to add this here.
8787
8788 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
8789 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
8790 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
8791 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
8792 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
8793 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
8794 gracefully stops.
8795
8796 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
8797 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
8798 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
8799
8800 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
8801 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
8802 bytes. Painful...
8803
8804
8805 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
8806 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
8807
8808 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
8809 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
8810 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
8811 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
8812 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
8813 reset, everything else should work fine.
8814
8815 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
8816 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
8817 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
8818 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
8819
8820 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
8821 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
8822 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
8823 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
8824
8825 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
8826
8827 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
8828 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
8829 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
8830 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8831
8832 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
8833 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
8834 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
8835 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
8836
8837 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
8838 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
8839 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8840
8841 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
8842 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
8843
8844 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
8845 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
8846 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
8847 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
8848 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
8849 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
8850 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
8851 clock frequency?
8852
8853 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
8854 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
8855 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
8856 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
8857 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
8858
8859 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
8860
8861 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
8862 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
8863 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
8864 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
8865 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
8866 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
8867 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
8868
8869 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
8870
8871 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
8872 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
8873 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
8874 up DRAM and loading it with code.
8875
8876 @anchor{faqtaporder}
8877 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
8878 particular order?
8879
8880 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
8881 the same order used by the hardware.
8882
8883 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
8884 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
8885 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
8886 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
8887 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
8888 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
8889
8890 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
8891 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
8892 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
8893 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
8894
8895 @itemize @bullet
8896 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
8897 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
8898 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
8899 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
8900 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
8901 @end itemize
8902
8903 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
8904
8905 @itemize @bullet
8906 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
8907 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
8908 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
8909 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
8910 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
8911 @end itemize
8912
8913
8914 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
8915 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
8916 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
8917
8918 TODO.
8919
8920 @end enumerate
8921
8922 @node Tcl Crash Course
8923 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
8924 @cindex Tcl
8925
8926 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
8927 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
8928 how the Tcl scripts work.
8929
8930 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
8931 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
8932 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
8933 OpenOCD.
8934
8935 @section Tcl Rule #1
8936 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
8937 @enumerate
8938 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
8939 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8940 @end enumerate
8941
8942 The Tcl equal is this:
8943
8944 @enumerate
8945 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
8946 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8947 @end enumerate
8948
8949 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
8950 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
8951
8952 @section Tcl Rule #1b
8953 There is a second pair of rules.
8954 @enumerate
8955 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
8956 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
8957 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
8958 in Tcl.
8959 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8960 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
8961 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
8962 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
8963 @end enumerate
8964
8965 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
8966 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
8967 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
8968 Everything is a string}
8969
8970 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
8971 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
8972 difference is subtle.
8973 @enumerate
8974 @item Parse Time
8975 @item Evaluation Time
8976 @end enumerate
8977
8978 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
8979 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
8980 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
8981
8982 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
8983 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
8984 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
8985 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
8986
8987 @itemize @bullet
8988 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
8989 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
8990 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
8991 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
8992 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
8993 @example
8994 # bash example
8995 X=`date`
8996 echo "The Date is: $X"
8997 # Tcl example
8998 set X [date]
8999 puts "The Date is: $X"
9000 @end example
9001 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9002 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9003 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9004 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9005 is a string}
9006 @example
9007 set x "Dinner"
9008 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9009 @end example
9010 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9011 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9012 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9013 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9014 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9015 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9016 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9017 @end itemize
9018
9019 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9020
9021 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9022
9023 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9024
9025 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9026 the normal way.
9027
9028 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9029 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9030 line is immedatly executed.
9031
9032 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9033 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9034
9035 @subsection Command Execution
9036
9037 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9038 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9039 control flow operators.
9040
9041 Commands are executed like this:
9042
9043 @enumerate
9044 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9045 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9046 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9047 @end enumerate
9048
9049 It sort of works like this:
9050 @example
9051 for(;;)@{
9052 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9053
9054 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9055
9056 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9057 @}
9058 @end example
9059
9060 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9061 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9062 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9063 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9064 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9065 ``LookupCommand()''
9066
9067 @subsection The FOR command
9068
9069 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9070 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9071 command just like any other command.
9072
9073 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9074 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9075 are:
9076
9077 @enumerate 0
9078 @item The ascii text 'for'
9079 @item The start text
9080 @item The test expression
9081 @item The next text
9082 @item The body text
9083 @end enumerate
9084
9085 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9086 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9087 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9088 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9089
9090 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9091 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9092
9093 @example
9094 int
9095 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9096 int *argc,
9097 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9098 @end example
9099
9100 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9101 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9102 still operates in the same basic way.
9103
9104 @subsection FOR command implementation
9105
9106 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9107 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9108
9109 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9110
9111 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9112
9113 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9114 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9115 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9116
9117 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9118 expression and returns a value.
9119
9120 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9121 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9122 @example
9123 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9124
9125 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9126
9127 int
9128 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9129 int argc,
9130 char **argv )
9131 @{
9132 if( argc != 5 )@{
9133 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9134 return ERROR;
9135 @}
9136
9137 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9138
9139 // Execute the start statement.
9140 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9141
9142 // Top of loop test
9143 for(;;)@{
9144 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9145 if( i == 0 )
9146 break;
9147
9148 // Execute the body
9149 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9150
9151 // Execute the LOOP part
9152 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9153 @}
9154
9155 // Return no error
9156 SetResult( interp, "" );
9157 return SUCCESS;
9158 @}
9159 @end example
9160
9161 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9162 in the same basic way.
9163
9164 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9165
9166 @subsection source and find commands
9167 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9168 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9169 @*Remember the parsing rules
9170 @enumerate
9171 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9172 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9173 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9174 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9175 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9176 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9177 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9178 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9179 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9180 @end enumerate
9181 @subsection format command
9182 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9183 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9184 @b{sprintf()}.
9185 @b{Example}
9186 @example
9187 set x 6
9188 set y 7
9189 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9190 @end example
9191 @enumerate
9192 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9193 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9194 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9195 @* Refer to Rule #1
9196 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9197 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9198 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9199 @end enumerate
9200 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9201 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9202 @example
9203 #1 Good
9204 proc someproc @{@} @{
9205 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9206 @}
9207 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9208 #2 Good - no variables
9209 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9210 #3 Good Curly Braces
9211 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9212 puts "Time: [date]"
9213 @}
9214 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9215 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9216 @end example
9217 @enumerate
9218 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9219 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9220 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9221 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9222 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9223 command.
9224 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9225 @*There are 4 examples:
9226 @enumerate
9227 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9228 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9229 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9230 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9231 @end enumerate
9232
9233 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9234 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9235 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9236
9237 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9238 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9239 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9240 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9241 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9242 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9243 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9244 @end enumerate
9245 @subsection Global Variables
9246 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9247 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9248 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9249 @example
9250 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9251 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9252 global x #Global variable X
9253 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9254 @}
9255 @end example
9256 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9257 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9258 @example
9259 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9260 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9261 # Create var name
9262 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9263 # Make it a global
9264 global $vn
9265 # Set it.
9266 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9267 @}
9268 @end example
9269 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9270 @example
9271 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9272 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9273 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9274 @}
9275 @end example
9276
9277 @include fdl.texi
9278
9279 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9280 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9281 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9282 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9283 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9284 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9285
9286 @printindex cp
9287
9288 @node Command and Driver Index
9289 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9290 @printindex fn
9291
9292 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)